Algebra 1: 2000 and Beyond - Ector County Independent School
Transcription
Algebra 1: 2000 and Beyond - Ector County Independent School
Algebra 1: 2000 and Beyond Mathematics Institute http://www.utdanacenter.org/ssi/projects/texteams Dwight D. Eisenhower Professional Development Program, Title II, Part B Texas Education Agency Texas Statewide Systemic Initiative in Mathematics, Science, and Technology Education Charles A. Dana Center, The University of Texas at Austin Permission is given to any person, group, or organization to copy and distribute Texas Teachers Empowered for Achievement in Mathematics and Science (TEXTEAMS) materials for noncommercial educational purposes only, so long as the appropriate credit is given. This permission is granted by The Charles A. Dana Center, a unit of the College of Natural Sciences at The University of Texas at Austin. Acknowledgements The TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond institute was developed under the direction and assistance of the following: Academic Advisors/Reviewers Paul Kennedy Texas Christian University Anne Papakonstantinou Rice University Writer Pam Harris Consultant Advisory Committee Linda Antinone Kathy Birdwell Kathi Cook Eva Gates Juan Manuel Gonzalez Susan Hull Paul Kennedy Laurie Mathis Diane McGowan Bonnie McNemar Barbara Montalto Anne Papakonstantinou Cindy Schimek Jane Silvey JoAnn Wheeler Susan Williams Fort Worth ISD New Braunfels ISD Dana Center, University of Texas at Austin Consultant Laredo ISD Dana Center, University of Texas at Austin Southwest Texas State University Dana Center, University of Texas at Austin Dana Center, University of Texas at Austin Consultant Texas Education Agency Rice University Katy ISD ESC VII ESC IV University of Houston TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Institute Table of Contents About TEXTEAMS Institutes......................................................................................vii Institute Introduction.....................................................................................................viii Institute Overview............................................................................................................. ix Section Overviews............................................................................................................x Materials List .......................................................................................................................x v I. Foundations for Functions 1 Developing Mathematical Models 1.1 Variables and Functions .....................................................................................1 Activity 1: Examples of Dependent Relationships .....................................11 Activity 2: Independent and Dependent Variables.....................................12 Reflect and Apply ............................................................................................13 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea ........................................................................................14 Activity 1: Valentine’s Day Idea .....................................................................24 Activity 2: Using Tables to Find the More Economical Offer.......................25 Activity 3: Using Graphs to Find the Better Offer.........................................27 Activity 4: New Rose Offers ..........................................................................29 Activity 5: Using Tables for New Rose Offers.............................................30 Activity 6: Using Graphs for New Rose Offers............................................31 Reflect and Apply ............................................................................................33 Student Activity: Investigate Recursively ...................................................36 2 Using Patterns to Identify Relationships 2.1 Identifying Patterns ...........................................................................................41 Activity 1: Painting Towers..............................................................................51 Activity 2: Building Chimneys ........................................................................54 Activity 3: Constructing Trucks........................................................................57 Activity 4: Generating Patterns.......................................................................60 Reflect and Apply ............................................................................................62 Student Activity: Perimeter of Rectangles ....................................................63 2.2 Identifying More Patterns.................................................................................67 Activity 1: Building Blocks...............................................................................72 Activity 2: Starting Staircases .........................................................................75 Activity 3: Too Many Triangles.......................................................................78 Reflect and Apply ............................................................................................81 3 Interpreting Graphs 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs.....................................................82 Activity 1: Walking Graphs .............................................................................87 Activity 2: Walking More Graphs...................................................................88 Reflect and Apply ............................................................................................90 Student Activity: Walk This Way ...................................................................91 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs .....................................................97 Activity 1: Matching Velocity Graphs.......................................................... 103 Activity 2: Connecting Distance and Velocity Graphs .............................. 105 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 107 TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond iii Table of Contents II. Linear Functions 1 Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function............................................................................ 108 Activity 1: ACT Scores................................................................................ 115 Activity 2: Temperatures.............................................................................. 116 Activity 3: Symbolic ..................................................................................... 117 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 118 Student Activity 1: Age Estimates.............................................................. 119 Student Activity 2: Sales Goals.................................................................. 128 1.2 The Y- Intercept............................................................................................. 132 Activity 1: The Birthday Gift......................................................................... 139 Activity 2: Spending Money....................................................................... 142 Activity 3: Money, Money, Money............................................................ 145 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 146 Student Activity: Show Me the Money! .................................................... 148 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change.......................................................................... 153 Activity 1: Wandering Around ..................................................................... 158 Activity 2: Describe the Walk ...................................................................... 160 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 162 Student Activity: What’s My Trend? .......................................................... 163 1.4 Finite Differences............................................................................................ 170 Activity 1: Rent Me!...................................................................................... 176 Activity 2: Guess My Function .................................................................... 177 Activity 3: Finite Differences......................................................................... 179 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 180 Student Activity: Graphs and Tables ......................................................... 181 2 Interpreting Relationships Between Data Sets 2.1 Out for a Stretch ............................................................................................. 183 Activity 1: Stretch It....................................................................................... 190 Activity 2: Comparing Graphs .................................................................... 194 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 195 Student Activity 1: Have You Lost Your Marbles?.................................. 196 Student Activity 2: Unidentified Circular Objects (UCO’s)....................... 206 Student Activity 3: Going to Great Depths................................................ 215 Student Activity 4: Height versus Arm Span ............................................ 224 2.2 Linear Regression.......................................................................................... 232 Activity 1: Sum of Squares ......................................................................... 245 Activity 2: Lines of Best Fit.......................................................................... 246 Activity 3: The Correlation Coefficient ........................................................ 248 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 250 3 Linear Equations and Inequalities 3.1 Solving Linear Equations .............................................................................. 251 Activity 1: Concrete Models........................................................................ 259 Activity 2: Using Concrete Models............................................................. 262 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 264 3.2 Stays the Same............................................................................................. 265 Activity: Stays the Same............................................................................. 274 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 278 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities ............................................................................ 279 Activity 1: Linear Inequalities in One Variable............................................ 288 Activity 2: Linear Inequalities in Two Variables.......................................... 290 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 294 TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond iv Table of Contents 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities............................................ 295 Activity 1: Using a Table.............................................................................. 302 Activity 2: Solve the System Graphically.................................................. 303 Activity 3: Solve the System Symbolically............................................... 305 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 306 Student Activity: Concrete Models and Systems of Linear Equations .. 307 III. Nonlinear Functions 1 Quadratic Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships................................................................................. 319 Activity 1: Building a Sandbox.................................................................... 329 Activity 2: Projectile Motion.......................................................................... 332 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 335 1.2 Transformations.............................................................................................. 336 Activity 1: Investigating the Role of a ......................................................... 344 Activity 2: Investigating the Role of k.......................................................... 345 Activity 3: Investigating the Role of h ......................................................... 346 Activity 4: Transformations .......................................................................... 347 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 350 1.3 Lines Do It Too .............................................................................................. 351 Activity 1: Exploring Slope ......................................................................... 361 Activity 2: Exploring Vertical Shifts ............................................................. 362 Activity 3: Exploring Horizontal Shifts......................................................... 363 Activity 4: A Different Perspective.............................................................. 365 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 366 2 Quadratic Equations 2.1 Connections ................................................................................................... 367 Activity 1: Roots, Factors, x-intercepts, Solutions..................................... 374 Activity 2: Which Form?............................................................................... 377 Activity 3: Jump!........................................................................................... 378 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 379 2.2 The Quadratic Formula................................................................................... 380 Activity 1: Programming the Quadratic Formula......................................... 384 Activity 2: Hang Time................................................................................... 385 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 387 Student Activity: Investigate Completing the Square.............................. 388 3 Exponential Functions and Equations 3.1 Exponential Relationships............................................................................ 392 Activity 1: Paper Folding.............................................................................. 405 Activity 2: Measure with Paper ................................................................... 407 Activity 3: Regions ...................................................................................... 409 Activity 4: How Big is a Region?................................................................ 411 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 413 Student Activity: Recursion Again............................................................... 414 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay................................................................... 420 Activity 1: Exponential Growth.................................................................... 427 Activity 2: Exponential Decay..................................................................... 428 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 429 Student Activity: On the Wall ...................................................................... 430 3.3 Exponential Models...................................................................................... 434 Activity 1: Population Growth...................................................................... 441 Activity 2: Cooling Down............................................................................. 443 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 444 TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond v 4 Interpreting Relationships Between Data Sets 4.1 Bounce It!........................................................................................................ 445 Activity 1: Collect the Data........................................................................... 452 Activity 2: A Bounce..................................................................................... 453 Activity 3: Bounce Height versus Bounce Number.................................. 454 Activity 4: Bounce Height versus Drop Height ......................................... 455 Reflect and Apply ......................................................................................... 456 Student Activity 1: Pattern Blocks............................................................... 457 Student Activity 2: Throw Up!..................................................................... 463 Student Activity 3: Radioactive Decay....................................................... 467 Student Activity 4: Pendulum Decay.......................................................... 474 Calculator Programs................................................................................................... 477 TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond vi About TEXTEAMS Institutes TEXTEAMS Philosophy • Teachers at all levels benefit from extending their own mathematical knowledge and understanding to include new content and new ways of conceptualizing the content they already possess. • Professional development experiences, much like the school mathematics curriculum itself, should focus on few activities in great depth. • Professional development experiences must provide opportunities for teachers to connect and apply what they have learned to their day-to-day teaching. Features of TEXTEAMS Institute Materials Multiple representations (verbal, concrete, pictorial, tabular, symbolic, graphical) Mathematical ideas will be represented in many different formats. This helps both teachers and students understand mathematical relationships in different ways. Integration of manipulative materials and graphing technology The emphasis of TEXTEAMS Institutes is on mathematics, not on learning about particular manipulative materials or calculator keystrokes. However, such tools are used in various ways throughout the institutes. Rich Connections within and outside mathematics Institutes focus on using important mathematical ideas to connect various mathematical topics and on making connections to content areas and applications outside of mathematics. Questioning strategies A variety of questions are developed within each activity that help elicit deep levels of mathematical understanding and proficiency. Hands-on approach with “get-up-and-move” activities Institutes are designed to balance intense thinking with hands-on experiences. Math Notes and Reflect and Apply A feature called Math Notes includes short discussions of mathematical concepts accompanying the learning activities. Similarly, the Reflect and Apply feature is designed to extend and apply participants’ understanding of the mathematical concepts. The Charles A. Dana Center is approved by the State Board for Educator Certification as a registered Continuing Professional Education (CPE) provider. Hours received in TEXTEAMS institutes may be applied toward the required training for gifted and talented in the area of curriculum and instruction. Individual district/ campus acceptance of these hours for gifted and talented certification is a local decision. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond vii TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Institute Introduction The Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Institute is based on the groundbreaking work of the 1996 TEXTEAMS Algebra I Institute. Both institutes assert that “Algebra for All” is a realistic and attainable goal. To teach “Algebra for All” will require educators to possess a deep understanding of mathematical content, pedagogy, and strategies to meet the needs of diverse student populations. This institute is not meant as a scope and sequence for the Algebra I course, nor is it a set of student activities for use in a classroom without careful thought and modification on the part of a knowledgeable teacher. The Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Institute is a rich, carefully designed professional development tool which is intended to deepen teacher content knowledge. It is also intended to model the importance of content depth by focusing on carefully selected activities that are few in number and grounded in the mathematics necessary to support teacher and student learning. The concepts and ideas explored within this institute are connected to classroom instruction and key assessments. In this institute, not all Algebra I topics can be addressed. It is important for teachers to develop a deep and powerful understanding of the concepts and ideas of algebra. This requires educators to understand the mathematics in a different capacity from that of the student. Therefore, content within the institute is approached from a more complex perspective and some topics are addressed at a level that is deeper than would be typical for Algebra I students. Much of the institute is built upon learning experiences that develop and promote the power of using concrete experiences to introduce and build mathematical concepts. Throughout the institute, multiple representations are utilized as a powerful strategy to assist educators and students in making connections, understanding mathematical concepts, and reasoning in meaningful and complex ways. The institute assumes some prior participant knowledge. If teachers are unfamiliar with the following, presenters may need to supplement with introductory materials. • Representing, adding and subtracting polynomials with algebra tiles (area model) • Using algebra tiles to model monomial and binomial multiplication • Modeling factoring trinomials with algebra tiles • Graphing calculators The Algebra I; 2000 and Beyond Institute draws on the work of the 1996 TEXTEAMS Algebra I Institute; Principles and Standards for School Mathematics, NCTM, 2000; Discovering Algebra, Key Curriculum Press, 2000; and Dr. Paul Kennedy, Southwest Texas State University. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond viii TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Institute Institute Overview I. Foundations for Functions 1 Developing Mathematical Models 2 Using Patterns to Identify Relationships 3 Interpreting Graphs II. Linear Functions 1 Linear Functions 2 Interpreting Relationships Between Data Sets 3 Linear Equations and Inequalities III. Nonlinear Functions 1 Quadratic Functions 2 Quadratic Equations 3 Exponential Functions and Equations 4 Interpreting Relationships Between Data Sets TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond ix I. Foundations of Functions Section Overviews I. Foundations of Functions Overview Activity Overview Developing Mathematical Models 1.1 Variables and Participants discuss the concept of function in Functions the context of a school fund-raising venture. 1.2 Valentine’s Day Participants investigate functional Idea relationships for a given problem situation using tables, graphs, and algebraic representations. Using Patterns to Identify Relationships 2.1 Identifying Participants represent linear relationships Patterns among quantities using concrete models, tables, diagrams, written descriptions, and algebraic forms. 2.2 Identifying More Participants represent non-linear Patterns relationships among quantities using concrete models, tables, diagrams, written descriptions, and algebraic forms. Interpreting Graphs 3.1 Interpreting Participants use motion detectors to Distance versus investigate distance over time graphs. This Time Graphs lays the groundwork for graph reading and for work with rates of change. 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs Participants use motion detectors to investigate velocity over time graphs. This continues to build graph-reading skills and to build understanding for rates of change. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond Materials butcher paper, masking tape graphing calculators building blocks, color tiles, graphing calculators building blocks, graphing calculators motion detector connected to an overhead calculator, motion detectors, data collection devices, graphing calculators, 2 or 3 transparencies cutto-fit on the overhead calculator screen motion detector connected to a overhead calculator, motion detectors, data collection devices, graphing calculators x II. Linear Functions Section Overviews II. Linear Functions Overview Activity Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function 1.2 The YIntercept 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change Overview Using contextual situations, participants investigate the linear parent function, the line y = x. Participants use “canned” real life experiences to build the concepts of yintercept as the starting point and slope as a rate of change, both with contextual significance. Participants use real data from a motion detector to model motion at a constant rate over time. Participants translate among algebraic, tabular, graphical, and verbal descriptions of linear functions. 1.4 Finite Differences Participants use their cumulative concrete experiences with the linear model to build to the abstract symbolic representations of slope. Finite differences are use to find linear models and to discover what makes data linear. Interpreting Relationships Between Data Sets 2.1 Out for a Participants investigate the relationship Stretch between the “stretch” of a rubber band attached to a container and the number of marbles in the container. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond Materials colored pencils or pens, pieces of flat spaghetti, graphing calculators Student Activity: markers, 1” grid paper graphing calculators motion detector connected to an overhead calculator, motion detectors, graphing calculators, data collection devices graphing calculators Student Activity: calculator programs Styrofoam cups, 3” long thin rubber bands, marbles of the same size, large paper clips, tape, meter sticks, graphing calculators Student Activities: blocks, PVC pipe, marbles, tape measure flashlights, rulers, cylinders, uniform objects, water xi II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression Section Overviews Participants write a program to find a least squares linear function to model data. They use the program and calculator regression to find linear models for data and they discuss the correlation coefficient, r. Linear Equations and Inequalities 3.1 Solving Linear Participants solve linear equations with Equations concrete models and make connections between the concrete model, abstract, and symbolic representations. 3.2 Stays the Participants solve linear equations in one Same variable, making connections between algebraic solution steps, algebra tile solution steps, and graphical solution steps. 3.3 Solving Linear Participants use problem situations and Inequalities technology to explore linear inequalities. 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities Participants use a table to develop a system of linear inequalities. They solve the system using various methods and make connections between a system of inequalities and a system of equations. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond graphing calculator, dynamic geometry program with a prepared demonstration of a linear least squares fit for data, computer with a projection device. algebra tiles, overhead algebra tiles algebra tiles, overhead algebra tiles, graphing calculators, 1” grid paper, markers transparencies of the Student Activity: Age Estimates from 2.1.1 The Linear Parent Function, graphing calculators graphing calculators Student Activity: algebra tiles xii III. Nonlinear Functions Section Overviews III. Nonlinear Functions Overview Activity Quadratic Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships Overview Participants use lists to develop a quadratic function representing the volume of a sandbox with a fixed depth. Using the quadratic function, participants solve quadratic equations numerically and graphically. 1.2 Participants investigate the effects of Transformations changing the parameters of quadratic function of the form y = ax2 + c. They apply this understanding by fitting a quadratic to real data. Participants extend their understanding and investigate the effects of changing the parameter h in 2 quadratic functions of the form y = ( x − h) . 1.3 Lines Do It Too Participants connect their knowledge of transformations with quadratic functions with the equations of lines. The point-slope form of a line is looked at from a transformational perspective. Quadratic Equations 2.1 Connections Participants make connections between the roots of quadratic functions and the solutions to quadratic equations and the factors of quadratic polynomials and the xintercepts of a parabola. They connect this understanding to the vertex, polynomial, and factored form of the equation of a parabola. Using this understanding, participants model a vertical jump, finding the height of the jump. 2.2 The Quadratic Participants program the quadratic formula Formula into the graphing calculator and use the program to solve quadratic equations at appropriate times. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond Materials graphing calculators, pieces of lumber or cardboard to simulate lumber graphing calculators, patty paper or blank transparencies graphing calculators, patty paper or blank transparencies graphing calculators, data collection devices, light sensors, laser pointers or flashlights graphing calculators, 1” graph paper, markers, meter sticks Student Activity: algebra tiles xiii III. Nonlinear Functions Exponential Functions and Equations 3.1 Exponential Participants explore exponential growth Relationships and decay situations. Using “canned” situations, participants develop the ideas of the common multiplier or ratio as the base of an exponential function and the starting point as the y-intercept of an exponential function. 3.2 Exponential Participants find models for exponential Growth and Decay growth and decay situations. 3.3 Exponential Participants find exponential models for Models given data sets. Interpreting Relationships Between Data Sets 4.1 Bounce It! Collecting three sets of data from a bouncing ball experiment, participants find appropriate models and justify their choices. TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond Section Overviews graphing calculators, sheets of blank paper graphing calculators Student Activity: sticky notes, poster boards, large blank paper, markers, tape graphing calculators balls, data collection devices, motion detectors, graphing calculators Student Activity: pattern blocks, balls, stop watches, graphing calculators, soda cans, string, meter sticks xiv Materials List Materials List Consumables butcher paper masking tape blank transparencies (some cut to fit the overhead graphing calculator) colored pencils or pens pieces of flat spaghetti markers 1” grid paper Styrofoam cups 3” thin rubber bands string marbles of the same size large paper clips water pieces of lumber or cardboard patty paper or blank transparencies blank paper sticky notes poster boards (large construction paper) balls (racket, basketball, golf) soda cans Non-Consumables building blocks meter sticks color tiles tape measure PVC pipe algebra tiles overhead algebra tiles flashlights cylinders uniform objects (to put in cylinders) Technology graphing calculators overhead graphing calculator data collection devices motion detectors light sensors computer with projection device laser pointers stop watches Software dynamic geometry program (w/ least squares demo) Calculator Programs: LINEGRPH LINETBL ACT CMOVE JUMPIT PENDULUM TEXTEAMS AlgebraI: 2000 and Beyond xv I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Leaders’ Notes 1.1 Variables and Functions Overview: Participants discuss the concept of function in the context of a school fundraising venture. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1) The student understands that a function represents a dependence of one quantity on another and can be described in a variety of ways. Terms: variable, function, independent variable, dependent variable, mathematical modeling Materials: butcher paper, masking tape Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Traditionally algebra has been taught as an abstract set of algorithms based on definitions, properties, and theorems that lead students to “an answer.” Finding x , sketching a graph, factoring an expression, and solving a word problem were the orders for the day. Devoid of context, these problems asked students to make a jump from their understanding of numbers and operations to the abstract notions of variables, equations, functions, etc. With contextrich problem situations, and using manipulatives and technology appropriately, we can bridge the gap between students’ concrete thinking and the abstract world of algebra. Transparency #1: Valentine’s Day Idea Introduce the school’s drill team money making project. • What factors might effect the success of the project? [Record at least one idea from each group.] Transparency #2: Variables and Functions Discuss list of factors that was acquired from field testing. Introduce the terms variables and functions. Transparency #3: Non-Mathematical Definition of Function Activity 1: Examples of Dependent Relationships Read the definition of function and have participant groups list at least 7 examples of dependent relationships on Activity 1. Have each group write examples on butcher paper and post on the walls of the room. Encourage participants to use varied language, not only “is a function of” and “depends on,” but also examples like, “The colder it gets, the more I shiver.” Have participants do a gallery tour and record two or three favorite examples. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 1 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Leaders’ Notes Transparency #4: Examples of Dependent Relationships Discuss examples on butcher paper and on Transparency #4. • Which examples show a clear dependent relationship? • Which examples, if any, do not show a clear dependent relationship? Activity 2: Independent and Dependent Variables Have the groups write some of their examples from Activity 1 and some of the examples from Transparency 4 in the chart as cause-and-effect statements. Some participants may word these in an if-then format. If no one does, help participants word a few in an if-then format. As you are discussing their examples, write the word “IF” under “Cause” and “THEN” under “Effect” in the table. Ask: • Which of these columns depends on the other? [The Effect column depends on the Cause column] Write “Dependent” under “THEN” • If “dependent” describes the second column, what word can we use to describe the first column? [Independent] Write “Independent” under “IF” So the table will look as follows: Cause IF Independent If I get more sleep at night, Effect THEN Dependent then I wake up faster. Math Note: Not all dependent relationships can be written in an if-then format. Consider the statement: “How I feel depends on how I eat.” You could infer meaning and rewrite it as “If I eat chocolate, then I will be happy.” Or “If I eat quickly, I will feel indigestion.” Also, not all relational statements should imply causation. Just because things are related does not necessarily mean that one causes the other. “Height is related to shoe size.” “People who spend the most time on the Internet have high rates of depression” Does that mean that time on the Internet causes depression or that depressed people gravitate toward the Internet? Be careful in the training to not infer causation just because there is relation. Sometimes determining which is the cause and which is the effect in a relation can be open to interpretation. The time and distance you fly in a plane are related. Does the distance you fly in an airplane depend on the time it takes to fly somewhere? Does the time it takes to fly somewhere depend on how far away the place is? The idea is to not get caught up being too picky. The focus of the activities is to connect participant’s previous understanding of cause and effect to the mathematical definition of function, with independent and dependent variables. Choose some good cause and effect relationships that illustrate TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 2 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Leaders’ Notes independent and dependent variables and don’t get hung up on those that do not. Transparency #5: Mathematical Definition of Function Traditionally many math teachers have introduced functions with the mathematical definitions. Students understand the concept of cause and effect. We use that understanding in Activities 1 – 2 to bridge to this mathematical definition. Introduce the mathematical definition of independent and dependent variables and discuss cause and effect relationships with variables. Transparency 6: Stages of Mathematical Modeling Process As with the Valentine’s Day idea, every business begins with a product or service that the owners believe will produce a profit. Creating the business idea is only the beginning stage. Soon decisions have to be made about how to best deliver the product or service so that the most money can be made. Several issues involve numbers, but simple arithmetic is seldom sufficient to handle all the varying possibilities. Algebraic methods will allow you (just as they allow businesses) to mathematically define some of the varying situations. You can put together variables and relationships into a mathematical model that describe a business situation and study questions (i.e., What would happen if one factor is changed?) so that optimum solutions can be identified. Use the following statements in discussing the stages of modeling. Businesses: ⇓ begin with a product or service that they believe will produce $$$$$, ⇓ identify issues that involve numbers and the use of algebraic methods to mathematically define some of the varying situations, ⇓ put together variables and relationships into a mathematical model that describes the business situation, ⇓ analyze the model by studying questions (i.e., What would happen if one factor is changed?) so that optimum solutions can be identified, ⇓ interpret the result within the context of the business situation, ⇓ use the information to formulate conclusions and to make informed decisions that will profit the business, and ⇓ implement plans based on the information gained through the use of the mathematical modeling process. Within real world situations, you must learn to: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 3 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Leaders’ Notes (1) identify problems and discern the important factors (variables/ parameters) that affect the problem, (2) determine the relationships among those factors (variables) and describe them mathematically, (3) analyze the model by applying appropriate mathematical techniques and draw mathematical conclusions, (4) interpret the results in context, (5) formulate conclusions and predictions so that optimum choices can be made, and (6) apply decisions to the real world situation. Answers to Reflect and Apply Often we ask students to match situations with graphs with little prior experience in making, reading, and interpreting such graphs. Ask participants to reflect on these Exercises as they progress through the institute. Ask participants to consider how students may be able to better match these graphs after the experiences suggested in the institute. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Summary: e d. c a b Building on the non-mathematical definitions of function and variables, participants are introduced to mathematical functions and mathematical modeling. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 4 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Transparency 1 Transparency 1: Valentine’s Day Idea The school’s drill team has decided on a money-making project for February. They plan to take orders (and money) for roses in advance and deliver them to the designated students on Valentine’s Day. What factors might affect the success of this moneymaking project? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 5 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Transparency 2 Transparency 2: Variables and Functions The success of the money-making project depends on many factors such as: • publicity, • appeal of project to the students, • selling price of roses, • cost of roses, • willingness of the flower distributors to work with the student group, and • cooperation of the administration. These factors are called variables because they can change regularly. It is appropriate to say that the success of the money-making project is a function of those variables. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 6 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Transparency 3 Transparency 3: Non-Mathematical Definition of Function The American Heritage Dictionary of the English Language defines function as something closely related to another thing and dependent upon it for its existence, value, or significance. Examples of Function 1. How fast I wake up in the morning depends on (is a function of) how much sleep I get. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 7 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Transparency 4 Transparency 4: Examples of Dependent Relationships 1. How fast I wake up in the morning depends on (is a function of) how much sleep I get. 2. Our height is a function of our age. 3. The amount of change in my pocket depends on (is a function of) the type of coins found there. 4. The amount of studying determines the grade we make. 5. As my car gets older, it is worth less. 6. The grass gets greener as I put more fertilizer on it. 7. The amount of money I make at my job depends on (is a function of) the number of hours I work. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 8 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Transparency 5 Transparency 5: Mathematical Definition of Function A mathematical function expresses a dependency relationship: one quantity depends in a systematic way on another quantity. For Example: y = 2 x + 1 is a function and expresses a dependency relationship. The value of y depends on the value of x. The variable x is called the input or independent variable. The variable y is called the output or dependent variable. In an applied mathematics setting, we must decide which decisions (input) influence or produce which results (output). In many cases this is a cause and effect relationship where the cause is the independent variable and the effect is the dependent variable. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 9 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Transparency 6 Transparency 6: Modeling with Mathematics Stages of Mathematical Modeling Process Entry Real world Situation Identify Apply Problem, Variables, Constraints Create Conclusions, Predictions, Decisions Mathematical Model Analyze/ Summarize Formulate Problem Situation TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Interpret Spring 2001 Mathematical Conclusions 10 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Activity 1 Activity 1: Examples of Dependent Relationships 1. How fast I wake up in the morning depends on (is a function of) how much sleep I get. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 11 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Activity 2 Activity 2: Independent and Dependent Variables Identify the independent and dependent variables from some of the dependent relationship examples. Cause TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Effect Spring 2001 12 I. Foundations for Functions 1.1 Variables and Functions: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Match the following descriptions with a graph: a. ___ 1. The volume of popcorn popping over time. ___ 2. Phone deal: $0.50 for the first 20 minutes and $0.07 per minute after. b. ___ 3. The worth of my car over time. c. ___ 4. He walked up and then down a hill, speed versus time. d. ___ 5. She walked away and then walked back, distance versus time. e. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 13 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea Overview: Participants investigate functional relationships for a given problem situation using tables, graphs, and algebraic representations. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1) The student understands that a function represents a dependence of one quantity on another and can be described in a variety of ways. (b.3) The student understands algebra as the mathematics of generalization and recognizes the power of symbols to represent situations. Terms: function, independent variable, dependent variable, pattern Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated in groups of 3 – 4. This entire activity is an overview problem to give participants a feel for a function based approach to algebra and for the power of multiple representations. Thus participants do not need to gain mastery at this point, but work to give them exposure to many of the goals and concepts of the institute. Activity 1: Valentine’s Day Idea Introduce the problem situation to the whole group. • Which seems better: 75 cents per rose or 50 cents per rose? $20 fixed cost or $60 fixed cost? 75 cents per rose plus $20 fixed cost or 50 cents per rose plus $60 fixed cost? Because students have a tendency to focus on certain parts of a problem situation while not attending to other parts, this line of questioning assists them in considering multiple variables at one time. • What kind of customer would order from Roses-R-Red? [A customer who needs a relatively small amount of flowers.] • What kind of customer would order from The Flower Power? [A customer who needs a relatively large amount of flowers.] Student Activity: Investigate Recursively Do the student activity with your participants as appropriate. Help participants generate the recursive routines, first without braces and then with braces. Note that both the original and the new rose offer are explored. Have participants point out questions that ask for an output value given an input value, and questions that ask for an input value given an output value. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 14 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes Doing activities like this helps students gain confidence in reading a math word problem. Math Note: Recursion is a process where each successive term is based on the previous term. Activity 2: Using Tables to Find the More Economical Offer Have participants complete the chart numerically first, looking for patterns. Develop the patterns live on the transparency of Activity 2 or use Transparency 1. Using the patterns, develop the function rules representing the cost from each flower shop. Ask participants to demonstrate the validity of their function rules for each flower shop. Have half of the group use the statistics capability of graphing calculators to enter the number of flowers sold into a list. Then enter the formula 20 + 0.75( List1) into the second list. Enter the formula 60 + 0.5( List1) into a third list. Check that the values generated match the values on the activity sheet. Have the other half of each group use the table building capability of graphing calculators to enter y = 20 + 0.75 x and y = 60 + 0.5 x . • What would you expect 240 roses to cost from Roses-R-Red? [If participants respond $220, then they do not understand that the “doubling effect” does not work here because this is not a proportional relation. A proportional relation is in the form y = mx .] Work through the rest of the Activity, using the following to discuss. 1. The cost of roses from Roses-R-Red is $20 and add $0.75 for every rose. Cost is 20 + 0.75( Number of Roses) , C = 20 + 0.75r . 2. The cost of roses from Flower Power is $60 and add $0.50 for every rose. Cost is 60 + 0.50( Number of Roses) , C = 60 + 0.50r . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 15 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes 3. Answers will vary, including increasing, increasing at different rates, increasing by constant amounts. 4. The cost increases as the number of roses purchased increases. The graph is linear with a positive slope. 5. Write the equation 65 = 20 + 0.75r , then look for the answer in the table. Write r = 60. Do not solve the equation algebraically at this time. 6. Write the equation 65 = 60 + 0.5r , then look for the answer in the table. Write r = 10 . As above, do not solve the equation algebraically at this time. Rather, suggest that this activity could be done before students have learned to solve one and two step equations. If students see equations like this in context, learn how to solve them using a table (and later in the activity, using a graph), then when students learn the algebraic steps to solving similar equations, they will already have context and purpose. Students will see algebraic methods as another way to find answers. Maybe we can eradicate, “Why do we have to find x anyway?” 7. Roses-R-Red offers the better deal for n < 160, there is not difference for n = 160 , and Flower Power offers the better deal for n > 160. 8. The point of intersection is (160, 140). This point signifies that at n=160 roses, the cost ($140) is the same with either flower dealer. 9. 20 + 0.75r = 60 + 0.50r . Activity 3: Using Graphs to Find the Better Offer Note that the ways in which two variables are related is not always shown clearly by tables of input-output values. Patterns in the data may be lost amid all the specific numbers. However, when data are displayed in a graph, it is often much easier to see trends and therefore to make predictions and/or informed decisions. First, have participants make a scatter plot of the data that was entered into lists (number of roses sold, cost from Roses-R-Red) and (number of roses sold, cost from Flower Power). Use the following questions to help participants graph the scatter plots and functions on the graphing calculator. • What do you think the graph will look like? Predict. • What viewing window makes sense for the problem situation? • What does the variable x represent? [Number of roses.] • What values make sense for the number of roses sold? [See Sample Answers below.] • What does the variable y represent? [Cost of roses] • What values make sense for the cost of roses? [See Sample Answers below.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 16 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes After they have graphed the scatter plots, graph the functions together with the plots. Make the connection between patterns seen in the tables of values and the graphs of the same ordered pairs. As the number of roses increases, the total cost increases. Make connections between the patterns seen in the graphs and the interpretation in the context. Note that to get from one point to another one, we must move to the right (increase in quantity) and then up (increase in cost) or we can move to the left (decrease in quantity) and then down (decrease in cost). Sample Answers: xmin=0: The variable x stands for the number of roses. It makes sense to look at the cost if no one bought a rose. xmax=270: We think that we might sell at most 270 roses. ymin= 0: The variable y stands for the cost of the roses. The cost will not be negative. ymax=200: This is a reasonable maximum cost for our maximum rose count of 270. • What does the ordered pair (210, 165) mean on the graph? [You can buy 210 roses for $165.] 3. The 75 cent per stem cost is the rate of change or slope of the line. The $20 is the y-intercept and in this case, it makes sense to call it the starting point. 4. The 50 cent per stem cost is the rate of change or slope of the line. The $60 is the y-intercept and in this case, it makes sense to call it the starting point. 5. The point of intersection is (160, 140), which means that it does not matter from whom you purchase 160 stems because it will cost $140 at both places. Show participants the following screen. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 17 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes 6. Roses-R-Red offers the better deal when you purchase less than 160 roses. Flower Power offers the better deal when you purchase more than 160 roses. Use the trace cursor to demonstrate. • What are the meanings of the coordinates on the screens? At Roses-R-Red, 110 stems cost $102.50. At Flower Power, 110 stems cost $115. At Roses-R-Red, 197 stems cost $167.75 At Flower Power, 197 stems cost $158.50. Discuss the meaning of slope and y-intercept within the context of this problem. For example, the algebraic rule y = 20 + 0.75 x yields (a) y-intercept of 20 which indicates the fixed cost that has to be paid initially and (b) slope of 0.75 which indicates the constant rate of change or the constant increase in cost for the purchase of each rose. Activity 4: New Rose Offer Introduce the new offer made by the distributors. Activity 5: Using Tables for New Rose Offers Encourage participants to complete the table so that comparisons between the table in Activity 2 and this one can be made. Discuss changes from old deal to new deal. Ask participants to share ways to assist students in making the connection between the table values and the corresponding graphs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 18 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes Note: Depending on the experience of your audience, you may want to continue to have them write sentences before they write function rules for each deal. Transparency 2: Comparing Tables • Looking at the table values for Roses-R-Red, what has happened to all of the costs, the y-values? [The y-values have all been decreased by 20.] • How has that affected the function representing the cost from Roses-RRed? [The starting point from the original offer has been decreased by 20, so the new function is 20 less than the original.] • Looking at the table values for Flower Power, what has happened to all of the costs, the y-values? [The y-values have also all been decreased by 20.] • How has that affected the function representing the cost from Flower Power? [The starting point from the original offer has been decreased by 20, so the new function is 20 less than the original.] Note that the slight modification made to the old deal is reflected in the function rules and their representations. For example, C = 20 + 0.75n Cn = 20 + 0.75n − 20 = 0.75n C = 60 + 0.5n Cn = 60 + 0.5n − 20 = 40 + 0.5n old offer by Roses-R-Red new offer by Roses-R-Red old offer by Flower Power new offer by Flower Power Making the connections above is an important precursor for the next section, graphing. Return to the table when you discuss the vertical translation (shift) in Activity 6. Activity 6: Using Graphs for New Rose Offer 1. Encourage participants to always predict what a graph will look like before looking at the graph on the calculator. 2. 3. The graph of the new rule is the graph of the original rule translated (shifted) down 20. Connect this with your comparisons in the table, where all of the costs, the y-values decreased by 20. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 19 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes 5. 6. The graph of the new rule is the graph of the original rule translated (shifted) down 20. Connect this with your comparisons in the table, where all of the costs, the y-values decreased by 20. 7. Show the following screens: The x-coordinates are the same! In other words, the “deal” is the same in that Roses-R-Red are still better for less than 160 stems and Flower Power are still better for over 160 stems. The costs are different by $20, but the answer to the question, “Who has the better deal?” remains the same. You can see this in the screens below, where a vertical line shows that the xcoordinates of the intersection points are the same. 8. A graph can be used in comparing the two dependent relations. We can see from the graphs that the two flower distributors charge the same amount when 160 roses are purchased. Use the trace cursor on both graphs to see that Roses-R-Red is less expensive when n < 160and Flower Power is less expensive when n > 160. Note the relationship between the graphical representation of the: 20 + 0.75 x = 60 + 0.50 x . original offers 0.75 x = 40 + 0.50 x . new offers Although both functions shift 20 units down the y-axis, the intersection of the transformed graphs has the same input value as the original graphs. • Why does this make sense algebraically? [Subtract 20 from both sides of the equation and the result is an equivalent equation, thus having the same solution. In both equations, x = 160 .] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 20 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Leaders’ Notes Extension: In the new rose deal, we looked at the effect of subtracting $20 from the cost of the roses from both flower dealers. Essentially, the deal remained the same in that Roses-R-Red were better for less than 160 stems and Flower Power were better for over 160 stems. Now, try looking at the effect of leaving the fixed costs the same and changing the amount of money per stem. Will the deal remain the same? Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. Flowers-R-Us sells roses for $1.00 a stem. y = x 2. All Occasion Roses sells roses for $10.00 plus $0.50 per stem. y = 10 + .5 x 3. The point of intersection (20, 20) tells us that we can buy 20 roses for $20 from either place. Buying less than 20 stems is a better deal from Flowers-R-Us and buying more than 20 stems is a better deal from All Occasion Roses. 4. You can purchase roses from R for $15.00 plus $1.25 per stem. 5. You can purchase roses from S for $35 plus $1.00 per stem. 6. The point of intersection (80, 115) tells us that we can buy 80 roses for $115 from either place. Buying less than 80 stems is a better deal from Flowers-R-Us and buying more than 80 stems is a better deal from All Occasion Roses. 7. With the coupon, roses are $2.00 plus $0.50 per stem. y = 2 + .5 x 8. Lilies cost $5.00 per stem. 9. Daisies cost $5.00 plus $0.25 per stem. 10. Summary: Fund-raising by selling roses for Valentines Day is the context for a rich problem where participants make connections between verbal, numerical, graphical, and algebraic representations of a linear situation. Participants build intuition for constant rates of change and y-intercepts of lines. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 21 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Transparency 1 Transparency 1: Using Tables to Find the More Economical Offer From the description of the two offers, complete the chart to find an algebraic rule that will determine the cost of n roses. Number of Roses Process Column 10 20 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 1000 20 + 0.75(10) 20 + 0.75(20) 20 + 0.75(30) 20 + 0.75(60) 20 + 0.75(90) 20 + 0.75(120) 20 + 0.75(150) 20 + 0.75(180) 20 + 0.75(210) 20 + 0.75(240) 20 + 0.75(1000) n 20 + 0.75n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Cost at Process RosesColumn R-Red $27.50 60 + 0.50(10) $35.00 60 + 0.50(20) $42.50 60 + 0.50(30) $65.00 60 + 0.50(60) $87.50 60 + 0.50(90) $110.00 60 + 0.50(120) $132.50 60 + 0.50(150) $155.00 60 + 0.50(180) $177.50 60 + 0.50(210) $200.00 60 + 0.50(240) $770.00 60 + 0.50(1000) Cost at Flower Power $65.00 $70.00 $75.00 $90.00 $105.00 $120.00 $135.00 $150.00 $165.00 $180.00 $560.00 60 + 0.50n Spring 2001 22 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Transparency 2 Transparency 2: Comparing Tables Original Offer Number of Roses Process Column 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 n 20 + 0.75(30) 20 + 0.75(60) 20 + 0.75(90) 20 + 0.75(120) 20 + 0.75(150) 20 + 0.75(180) 20 + 0.75(210) 20 + 0.75(240) 20 + 0.75n Cost at Process RosesColumn R-Red $42.50 60 + 0.50(30) $65.00 60 + 0.50(60) $87.50 60 + 0.50(90) $110.00 60 + 0.50(120) $132.50 60 + 0.50(150) $155.00 60 + 0.50(180) $177.50 60 + 0.50(210) $200.00 60 + 0.50(240) 60 + .50 n Cost at Flower Power $75.00 $90.00 $105.00 $120.00 $135.00 $150.00 $165.00 $180.00 New Offer Number of Roses (new) 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 n Process Column 0.75(30) 0.75(60) 0.75(90) 0.75(120) 0.75(150) 0.75(180) 0.75(210) 0.75(240) 0.75n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Cost at RosesR-Red $22.50 $45.00 $67.50 $90.00 $112.50 $135.00 $157.50 $180.00 Spring 2001 Process Column 40 + .50(30) 40 + .50(60) 40 + .50(90) 40 + .50(120) 40 + .50(150) 40 + .50(180) 40 + .50(210) 40 + .50(240) 40 + .50 n Cost at Flower Power $55.00 $70.00 $85.00 $100.00 $115.00 $130.00 $145.00 $160.00 23 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 1 Activity 1: Valentine’s Day Idea The school’s drill team has contacted several flower distributors and has narrowed the choice to two companies. Option 1: Roses-R-Red has offered to sell its roses for a fixed down payment of $20 and an additional charge of 75 cents per stem. Option 2: The Flower Power has offered to sell its roses for a fixed down payment of $60 and an additional charge of 50 cents per stem. Which is the more economical offer? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 24 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 2 Activity 2: Using Tables to Find the More Economical Offer From the description of the two offers, complete the chart to find an algebraic rule that will determine the cost of n roses. Number of Roses Cost at Process Roses-RColumn (Roses-R-Red) (Flower Power) Red Process Column Cost at Flower Power 10 20 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 1000 n 1. Write a sentence and a function rule for the cost of roses from Roses-are-Red. 2. Write a sentence and a function rule for the cost of roses from Flower Power. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 25 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 2 3. What patterns do you observe from the table of values? 4. What happens to the cost of the roses as the number of roses purchased increases? What would a graph of this relationship look like? 5. How many roses can you buy from Roses-are-Red for $65.00? 6. How many roses can you buy from Flower Power for $65.00? 7. Which company offers the better deal? 8. Is there a point where the two flower dealers charge the same total amount? If so, what is the charge? If not, why do the costs never equal? 9. Write an equation that represents the point where the two flower shops charge the same amount. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 26 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 3 Activity 3: Using Graphs to Find the Better Offer 1. Find an appropriate viewing window for the graphs of both functions. Sketch both functions here and label. 2. Justify your viewing window choice: xmin: xmax: ymin: ymax: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 27 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 3 3. What effect does the 75 cents per stem cost have on the graph of the Roses-R-Red function? What effect does the $20 have on the graph? 4. What effect does the 50 cents per stem cost have on the graph of the Roses-R-Red function? What effect does the $60 have on the graph? 5. What are the coordinates of the point of intersection of the two functions? What is the significance of this point? 6. Which flower dealer offers the better deal? Justify your answer. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 28 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 4 Activity 4: New Rose Offers To entice these potential new customers, Roses-R-Red decides to eliminate its fixed charge of $20. According to its new offer, the drill team pays only for the roses they buy. When the Flower Power learns about the new offer by its competitor, it immediately enters the price war by reducing its fixed charge also by $20. Which new deal is the better offer? How does the new offer compare to the original offer? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 29 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 5 Activity 5: Using Tables for New Rose Offers From the description of each of the two new deals, complete the chart and write new algebraic rules that will determine the cost of n roses. Cost at Process Cost at Number Process Roses-RColumn Flower of Roses Column (Roses-R-Red) (Flower Power) Red Power 10 20 30 60 90 120 150 180 210 240 270 300 n 1. What patterns do you observe in the new table of values? 2. Compare the costs on this chart to the costs on the first chart. What changes do you observe? Predict what the graphs will look like. 3. Which company offers the better deal? 4. Is there a point where the two flower dealers charge the same amount? If so, what is the charge? 5. Write an equation that represents the point where the two flower shops charge the same amount. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 30 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 6 Activity 6: Using Graphs for New Rose Offers 1. On your graphing calculator graph only the original Roses-RRed function, y = 20 + 0.75 x . Now, predict what you think the graph of the new offer, y = 0.75 x , will look like. 2. Graph both the original offer, y = 20 + 0.75 x , and the new offer, y = 0.75 x , together. 3. What effect does subtracting $20 from the old rule have on the new graph of the Roses-R-Red function? 4. Turn off the above two graphs. Graph only the original Flower Power function, y = 60 + 0.5 x . Now, predict what you think the graph of the new offer will look like, y = 40 + 0.5 x . 5. Graph both the original offer, y = 60 + 0.5 x , and the new offer, y = 40 + 0.5 x , together. 6. What effect does subtracting $20 from the old rule have on the new graph of the Flower Power function? 7. Graph all four functions at the same time. What are the coordinates of the point where the two new functions intersect? What is the significance of this point? 8. Which flower dealer now offers the better deal? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 31 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Activity 6 9. Sketch the graphs of all four functions and label the relevant points of intersection. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 32 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Describe the rose deal represented by the graph with a sentence and a function. Flowers-R-Us Cost $10 5 Number of Roses All Occasion Roses 2. Describe the rose deal represented by the graph with a sentence and a function. Cost $10 5 Number of Roses 3. Using your graphing calculator, graph the above two rose deals together in the same window, find the point of intersection and discuss what the point means in the fundraising context. Sketch the window with the two graphs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 33 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Reflect and Apply 4. Describe the rose deal represented by the function: R( x ) = 15 + 1.25 x 5. Describe the rose deal represented by the function: S( x ) = 35 + x 6. Sketch the graphs of the above two rose deals below, find the point of intersection and discuss what the point means in the fund-raising context. Use your graphing calculator to confirm. 7. The drill team has a coupon for All Occasion Roses for $8 off the purchase of roses. Find a function to represent the cost of buying roses from All Occasion Roses if there was no minimum purchase required. Write the function and sketch the graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 34 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Reflect and Apply 8. Describe the flower deal represented by the table. Number of Lilies 0 1 2 3 4 Cost $0.00 $5.00 $10.00 $15.00 $20.00 9. Describe the flower deal represented by the table. Number of Daisies 0 1 2 3 4 Cost $5.00 $5.25 $5.50 $5.75 $6.00 10. Sketch the graphs of the functions in Exercises 8 and 9 on the grid below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 35 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Student Activity Student Activity: Investigate Recursively Overview: Using the power of the graphing calculator, students explore problems recursively. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1) The student understands that a function represents a dependence of one quantity on another and can be described in a variety of ways. (b.3) The student understands algebra as the mathematics of generalization and recognizes the power of symbols to represent situations. Terms: Recursion Materials: Graphing calculators Procedures: Student Activity: Investigate Recursively Do exercises 1 – 6 with students, using an overhead calculator to demonstrate. Then have students complete the New Rose Offers exercises. 1. Help students generate the recursive routines as follows, first without braces and then with braces. 2. 3. $44.00 4. 23 roses 5. $76.00 6. 43 roses TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 36 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Student Activity New Rose Offers 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. A fixed charge of $50 with $1.00 per rose. 8. A fixed charge of $10 with $1.25 per rose. 9. No fixed charge with $0.90 per rose. 10. No fixed charge with $0.50 per rose. 11. A fixed charge of $30 with $0.35 per rose. Note: A recursively defined sequence is defined by a starting value and a rule. You generate the sequence by using the rule on the starting value and then again on the resulting value and so on. Traditionally we have focused on functions written in closed form in a first year algebra class. In the institute, we use recursion to lead students to writing equations to model situations. Summary: Students naturally operate recursively. We capitalize on this and use the power of the graphing calculator to explore some linear situations, looking for both input and output answers. Students build confidence in reading and understanding word problems. Students build intuition for constant rates of change and y-intercepts in linear situations. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 37 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Student Activity Student Activity: Investigate Recursively Roses-R-Red has offered to sell its roses for a fixed down payment of $20 and an additional charge of 75 cents per stem. The Flower Power has offered to sell its roses for a fixed down payment of $60 and an additional charge of 50 cents per stem. 1. Generate a recursive routine to investigate the Roses-R-Red offer. 2. Generate a recursive routine to investigate the Flower Power offer. Using your recursive routine, answer the following: 3. How much would it cost to order 32 roses from Roses-RRed? 4. How many roses can you order from Roses-R-Red for $37.25? 5. How much would it cost to order 32 roses from Flower Power? 6. How many roses can you order from Flower Power for $81.50? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 38 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Student Activity New Rose Offers To entice these potential new customers, Roses-R-Red decides to eliminate its fixed charge of $20. According to its new offer, the drill team pays only for the roses they buy. When the Flower Power learns about the new offer by its competitor, it immediately enters the price war by reducing its fixed charge also by $20. 1. Generate a recursive routine to investigate the new Roses-RRed offer. 2. Generate a recursive routine to investigate the new Flower Power offer. Using your recursive routine, answer the following: 3. Now how much would it cost to order 43 roses from RosesR-Red? 4. Now how many roses can you order from Roses-R-Red for $27.00? 5. How much would it cost to order 43 roses from Flower Power? 6. How many roses can you order from Flower Power for $58.00? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 39 I. Foundations for Functions 1.2 Valentine’s Day Idea: Student Activity Students decided to check around at other shops. Based on the screen shots below, what kind of deals did they find? 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 40 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2.1 Identifying Patterns Overview: Participants represent linear relationships among quantities using concrete models, tables, diagrams, written descriptions, and algebraic forms. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1) The student understands that a function represents a dependence of one quantity on another and can be described a variety of ways. (b.2.B) For a variety of situations, the student identifies the mathematical domains and ranges and determines reasonable domain and range values for given situations. (b.2.C) The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. (b.3) The student understands algebra as the mathematics of generalization and recognizes the power of symbols to represent situations. (c.1.B) The student determines the domain and range values for which linear functions make sense for given situations. Terms: function, independent variable, dependent variable Materials: building blocks, color tiles, graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Do the Student Activity depending on the level of participants. Activity 1: Painting Towers Do the Activity together as a whole group, bringing out the following points and asking the indicated questions. 1. Encourage participants to write how they found the number of faces to paint in the process column. This can often be done in several ways, which will lead to different, yet equivalent algebraic expressions. This is a desired outcome. Possible equivalent expressions include: 4 +1 2( 4 ) + 1 3( 4) + 1 n( 4) + 1 = 4n + 1 2 + 2 +1 2(2) + 2(2) + 1 3(2) + 3(2) + 1 n(2) + n(2) + 1 5 5+4 5 + 2( 4) 5 + (n − 1)( 4) Ask participants to use the cubes to physically demonstrate the algebraic rules they found in the table. In this example, they will mainly be pointing to faces on the cubes and relating them to the heights of the towers. Note: encourage participants to obtain the equivalent expressions from the model, not by simplifying the algebraic expressions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 41 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2. Discuss with participants that choosing appropriate windows and then justifying window choices is a precursor to students learning about domain and range. Graph the function over the scatter plot to verify as shown above. 3. 4. 4 x + 1 = 25 4 x = 24 x=6 • • What does the ordered pair (8, 33) mean? [For term number 8 (figure 8 or a tower 8 cubes high), the numerical term value (number of faces to paint) is 33.] Does the ordered pair (12,50) belong to this graph? Why or why not? [A simple answer might be that there will always be that extra top face to paint, and therefore the number of faces to paint will be odd. Thus it is not possible for there to be 50 faces to paint. Also, the symbolic rule suggests odd numbers.] 5. Examples: 6+2 2(6) + 2 3(6) + 2 n(6) + 2 = 6n + 2 2(3 + 1) 2(2(3) + 1) 2(3(3) + 1) 2(n(3) + 1) = 2(3n + 1) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 42 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 6. Sample answer: For 35 cubes in each column: you need to paint 6 faces times 35 plus the top 2 faces. 7. F = 6n + 2 9. • What changed in the rule? The figure? The graph? The domain? The range? Compare. Use the following questions to compare the single tower situation and the double tower situation. • What represents the “changing quantity” and what represents the “fixed quantity” in the pattern? [The addition of 4 faces with each additional cube represents the changing quantity in the single tower. The addition of 6 faces with each additional level represents the changing quantity in the double tower. The faces on tops of the towers represents the unchanging one and two faces.] • What number in the rule affects the slope, steepness, of the line? [The coefficient of x . In this case, it is the number 4 in the single tower and the number 6 in the double tower.] • What number in the rule affects the starting point for the scatter plot (y-intercept for the line)? [The constant. In the first case, it is the number 1, and in the second case, the number 2.] Underline the constants in both of the functions, y = 1 + 4 x and y = 2 + 8x . • What do the constants represent in the functions, y = 1 + 4 x and y = 2 + 8 x ? [faces to paint] Circle the coefficient of x in both of the functions, y = 1 + 4 x and y = 2 + 8x . • What do the coefficients of x represent? [faces to paint per tower height or faces to paint per figure number.] Repeat the above questions for Activities 2 – 3. Activity 2: Building Chimneys Have participants do Activity 2 together in groups. Discuss as a whole group, asking several participants to share their different methods of arranging the cubes to find appropriate expressions. 1. Encourage participants to write how they found the number of blocks in the process column. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 43 I. Foundations for Functions For example: 6 + 2(1) 6 + 2(2) 6 + 2(3) 6 + 2n 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2 + 2(2 + 1) 2 + 2(2 + 2) 2 + 2(2 + 3) 2 + 2(2 + n) 2. Graph the function over the scatter plot to verify as shown. A reasonable domain for the situation is 0 to 10 blocks and a reasonable range is 0 to 26 blocks. 3. You need 6 blocks for the base and then 23 rows of 2 blocks for the chimney. The ordered pair is (23, 52). 4. You need 28 blocks to build a house with a chimney 11 blocks high. The ordered pair is (11, 28). 5. No, the ordered pair (13, 34) does not belong to the graph because if you were building figure 13, you would need 13(2) + 6 = 32 blocks, not 34. 6. Examples: 9+1 9+2 9+3 9+n 3 + 3 + (3 + 1) 3 + 3 + (3 + 2) 3 + 3 + (3 + 3) 3 + 3 + (3 + n) 7. Sample answer: The total number of blocks equals 9 plus the number of blocks in the chimney. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 44 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 9. • What changed in the rule? The figure? The graph? Compare. Activity 3: Constructing Trucks 1. Encourage participants to write how they found the number of blocks in the process column. For example: 3+2 2+2+1 3(2) + 2 3+3+2 3(3) + 2 4+4+3 3n + 2 2(n+1) + n 2. Graph the function over the scatter plot to verify as shown. 3. You need 152 blocks for the 50th figure. 4. If you use 242 blocks, you are on the 80th figure (term number). 2 + 3n = 242 3n = 240 n = 80 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 45 I. Foundations for Functions 5. Examples: 3+1 3(2) + 1 3(3) + 1 3n + 1 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2+2 2(2) + 3 2(3) + 4 2n + (n + 1) 6. Sample answer: The total number of blocks equals 1 plus 3 times the figure number. 8. The second scatter plot, with one block on top of each truck starts (the yintercept is) lower than the previous plot, with two blocks on the top of each truck. 10. The graph starts higher than the original because now you have a constant 4 blocks on top of each truck. The graph is steeper than the original because you are now adding 6 blocks each time, instead of 3. Compare Activities 1 – 3 Use the following questions to compare the previous activities. • What changed in the rule? The figure? The graph? Compare. • What represents the “changing quantity” and what represents the “fixed quantity” in each of the patterns? • What number in the rule changes the slope of the line? • What number in the rule affects the starting point for the line? On graphs of the lines generated in the Activities, draw triangles to show the idea that all of these rules have a constant rate of change, each time the same thing was changing. See below for an example. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 46 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes Activity 4: Generating Patterns Have half of the groups generate patterns that model surface area, similar to Activity 1: Painting Towers. Have the other half of the groups generate patterns that model volume (number of cubes), similar to Activity 2: Building Chimneys and Activity 3: Constructing Trucks. Sample answers: 1. How many faces to paint: Term Number 1 Visual (Figure) Written Description Paint 4 lateral faces and the top and bottom. Paint 4 lateral faces twice and the top and bottom. Paint 4 lateral faces three times and the top and bottom. 2 3 Process Column 4+2 Total Faces to Paint 6 2( 4) + 2 10 3( 4) + 2 14 4n + 2 n How many blocks to build: Term Number 1 Visual (Figure) Written Description Base of 4 plus 2. Process Column 4+2 Number of Blocks 6 2 Base grows by 4 plus the 2 on top. 2( 4) + 2 10 3 Base grows by 4 more plus the 2 on top. 3( 4) + 2 14 4n + 2 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 47 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2. How many faces to paint: Term Number 1 Visual (Figure) Written Description Paint the two faces on the end plus the 8 front and back faces. Paint the 2 new front and back faces plus the two on the end plus the original 8 lateral faces. Add the 2 new faces to the previous. 2 3 Process Column 2+8 Faces to Paint 10 2(2) + 8 12 3(2) + 8 14 2n + 8 n How many blocks to build: Term Number 1 Visual (Figure) Written Description Base of 8 plus 2. Process Column 8+2 Number of Blocks 10 2 Base of 8 plus 2 rows of 2 on top. 8 + 2( 2 ) 12 3 Base of 8 plus 3 rows of 2 on top. 8 + 3(2) 14 8 + 2n n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 48 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 20 15 10 5 1 2 3 4 Term Number Note that both exercises in Activity 4 are examples of doing and undoing – an important habit of mind for algebraic thinking. Math Note: The manipulative model (using blocks to build figures to represent patterns) has inherent domain and range restrictions. The sequences generated in the table are for whole number input (domain) values. For example, you would not build figures with 0.5 or 0.3 of a block. The algebraic equations developed in this Activity are linear. The domain and range of a line are all real numbers Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. The first set of figures show adding 3 blocks every time (3x) to a constant 6 blocks, 3 x + 6 . The second set of figures show 3 groups of adding a block every time, x, to a constant 2 blocks, 3( x + 2) . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 49 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2. b 3. d 4. a 5. c As an extension, ask participants to label the axes with units and explain their reasoning. Summary: By using concrete models and the process column, participants model linear patterns and explore constant rates of change. Participants model both input and output questions with equations and solve them using tables and graphs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 50 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 1 Activity 1: Painting Towers Suppose you are painting a tower built from cubes, based on the pattern below. Use the table to find the relationship between the number of faces to paint and the number of blocks in the tower. (Paint only the sides and the top.) Term Visual Written Number (Figure) Description (Number of blocks) A 1 cube-high 1 tower has 5 faces to paint. 2 Process Column Numerical Value of Term (Faces to Paint) 5 9 3 4 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 51 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 1 1. Use the process column to write a function that expresses the relationship between the number of faces to be painted and the number of cubes. 2. Graph the data from your table on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator. What is a reasonable domain for this situation? A reasonable range? 3. How many faces need to be painted for a 25 cube tower? Explain two ways of getting an answer. 4. If the tower you paint has 25 faces, how many cubes are in the tower? Explain two ways of getting an answer. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 52 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 1 5. Suppose you have two adjacent columns of cubes instead of the one column as before. Use your cubes to build the first four figures and determine the number of faces that need to be painted. Term Visual Written Process Numerical Number (Figure) Description Column Value of Term (Faces to Paint) 1 2 3 4 n 6. Write a rule in words to describe how to find the total number of faces that need to be painted for two columns of cubes with 35 cubes in each column. 7. Write a rule in symbols that expresses the relationship between the number of cubes in each column and the total number of faces to be painted. 8. Predict how the graph of this data differs from the graph of the original data. Explain. 9. Graph the above data on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator and compare to the previous graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 53 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 2 Activity 2: Building Chimneys Suppose you are building a house with a chimney, based on the pattern below. Use the table to find the relationship between the number of blocks you need and the term number. Term Number 1 Visual (Figure) Written Description A house with a chimney 1 block high takes 8 blocks to build. 2 Process Column Numerical Value of Term (number of blocks) 8 10 3 4 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 54 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 2 1. Use the process column to write a function that expresses the relationship between the total number of blocks needed to build the house and the term number. 2. Graph the data from your table on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator. What is a reasonable domain for this situation? A reasonable range? Explain. 3. Use words to describe how to use blocks to build a house with a total of 52 blocks. What is this ordered pair on the graph? 4. If a house has a chimney that is 11 blocks high, how many blocks will you need to build the house? What is this ordered pair on the graph? 5. Does the ordered pair (13, 34) belong to this graph? How do you know? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 55 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 2 6. Suppose the chimney is made of 1 block instead of two and the house is built of three rows of 3 blocks instead of two rows of 3 blocks. Use your cubes to build the first three figures and record the data below. Term Visual Written Process Numerical Number (Figure) Description Column Value of Term 1 2 3 4 n 7. Write a rule for this new data that expresses the relationship between the total number of blocks and the number of blocks in the chimney for a house. 8. Predict how the graph of this data differs from the graph of the original data. Explain. 9. Graph the above data on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator and compare to the previous graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 56 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 3 Activity 3: Constructing Trucks Suppose you are building a truck, based on the pattern below. Use the table to find the relationship between the number of blocks you need and the figure number. Term Number 1 Visual (Figure) Written Description The truck has a base of 3 blocks with 2 blocks on top. 2 Process Column Numerical Value of Term 5 8 3 4 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 57 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 3 1. Use the process column to write a function that expresses the relationship between the total number of blocks needed to build the truck and the term number. 2. Graph the data from your table on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator. What is a reasonable domain for this situation? A reasonable range? 3. Find the total number of blocks needed for the 50th figure. 4. If there are a total of 242 blocks, what term number is this? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 58 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 3 5. Suppose there is only one block on the top of each truck. Use your cubes to build the first three figures and record the data below. Term Visual Written Process Numerical Number (Figure) Description Column Value of Term 1 2 3 4 n 6. Write a rule for this new data that expresses the relationship between the total number of blocks and the figure/term number. 7. Predict how the graph of this data differs from the graph of the original data. Explain. 8. Graph the above data on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator and compare to the previous graph. What effect did changing the number of blocks on top of the truck have on the graph? 9. Suppose the original trucks (2 blocks on top) were built “double-wide.” Predict how the graph differs from the original. 10. Build the first three “double-wide” trucks and graph the data on your graphing calculator. How does this graph compare to the graph of the original? Why? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 59 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 4 Activity 4: Generating Patterns 1. Given the following graph, use blocks to generate a sequence of figures that fits the data. Fill in the table and sketch the figures. 20 15 10 5 1 2 3 4 Term Number Term Number Visual (Figure) Written Description Process Column Numerical Value of Term 1 2 3 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 60 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Activity 4 2. Given the function y = 2 x + 8 , use blocks to generate a sequence of figures that fits the function. Fill in the table, sketch the figures, and plot the graph. Label the graph. Term Number Visual (Figure) Written Description Process Column Numerical Value of Term 1 2 3 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 61 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Create a physical model to demonstrate 3 x + 6 = 3( x + 2) . Match: 2. ____ y = 3 + x a b 3. ____ y = x c 4. ____ y = 3 + 2 x d 5. ____ y = 2 x 6. Reflect on the activities. How might you adapt the activities to use with your students? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 62 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Student Activity Student Activity: Perimeter of Rectangles Overview: Students investigate linear relationships using concrete models, tables, diagrams, written descriptions, and algebraic forms. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1) The student understands that a function represents a dependence of one quantity on another and can be described a variety of ways. (b.3) The student understands algebra as the mathematics of generalization and recognizes the power of symbols to represent situations. Terms: function, independent variable, dependent variable, pattern Materials: color tiles, graphing calculator Procedures: Students should be seated in groups of 3 – 4. Activity : Perimeter of Rectangles Do the activity together as a whole group, bringing out the following points and asking the indicated questions. 1. Encourage students to write how they found the number of perimeter in the process column. This can often be done in several ways, which will lead to different, yet equivalent algebraic expressions. This is a desired outcome. Possible equivalent expression include: Sample Process 1+1+1+1 2+2+2+2 3+3+3+3 n+n+n+n Sample Process 4(1) 4(2) 4(3) 4n Sample Process 2. Justify: The variable x stands for the figure number and xmin=0 to xmax=5 shows the figures 1 – 4 nicely. The variable y stands for the perimeter and ymin= −2 to ymax=20 shows the perimeters of 4 to 18 nicely. 3. The perimeter of figure 11 is 44. 4(11) = 44 4. Figure 12 has a perimeter of 48. 4n = 48 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 63 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Student Activity Ask students to use the tiles to physically demonstrate the algebraic rules they found in the table. In this example, they will mainly be pointing to sides on the tiles and relating them to the numbers in the process column. 5. Sample Process 2 +1+ 2 +1 3+2+3+2 4+3+ 4+3 (n + 1) + n + (n + 1) + n Sample Process 2(2) + 2(1) 2(3) + 2(2) 2( 4) + 2(3) 2(n + 1) + 2(n) Sample Process 4(1) + 2 4(2) + 2 4(3) + 2 4(n) + 2 6. 7. Figure 11 has a perimeter of 46. 4(11) + 2 = 46 . 8. Figure 13 has a perimeter of 54. 4n + 2 = 54 . Ask students to use the tiles to physically demonstrate the algebraic rules they found in the table. For example, the rule in the first column above is simply adding each side in order. The rule in the second column above is noting that there are two sides of length n+1 and two sides of length n. The rule in the third column above is based on the idea of adding two additional sides to a square of side n. Ask students to compare the rules, P = 4n and P = 4n + 2, and their respective graphs. Note that the lines have the same slope but that the line P = 4n + 2 is the line P = 4n shifted up two. The perimeters grow by the same amount each time you change figure numbers by one, but P = 4n + 2 starts 2 higher than P = 4n . Summary Using multiple representations, students gain added understanding for the linear relationship of a rectangle’s perimeter and the length of a side. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 64 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Student Activity Student Activity: Perimeter of Rectangles Build these squares and the next three squares in the sequence, using color tiles. Figure number 1, 2, 3 Figure 1. Complete the table, using the process column to write a function for figure n, and graph the relation. Figure Number (length of side) 1 2 3 4 5 Process Perimeter n Length of Side 2. On your graphing calculator, make a scatter plot. Graph the function over the scatter plot to confirm. Justify your window choice. Answer the questions and write the equation that represents the question: 3. What is the perimeter of figure number 11? 4. What figure number has a perimeter of 48? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 65 I. Foundations for Functions 2.1 Identifying Patterns: Student Activity Build these rectangles and the next three rectangles in the sequence, using color tiles. Figure number 1, 2, 3 Figure 5. Complete the table, using the process column to write a function for perimeter of the nth figure, and graph the relation. Figure Number (length of side) 1 2 3 4 5 Process Perimeter n Length of Side 6. On your graphing calculator, make a scatter plot. Graph the function over the scatter plot to confirm. Justify your window choice: Answer the questions and write the equation that represents the question: 7. What is the perimeter of figure number 11? 8. What figure number has a perimeter of 54? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 66 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2.2 Identifying More Patterns Overview: Participants represent non-linear relationships among quantities using concrete models, tables, diagrams, written descriptions, and algebraic forms. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.C) The student describes functional relationships for given problem situations and writes equations or inequalities to answer questions arising from the situations. (d.2.A) The student solves quadratic equations using concrete models, tables, graphs, and algebraic methods. (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: function, independent variable, dependent variable Materials: building blocks, graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Have participants do Activities 1 and 2 in their groups. Again encourage participants to do the process column in several ways, leading to different, yet equivalent algebraic expressions. Give groups the transparencies of the activities and have them present their results, using overhead tiles to demonstrate different ways of physically modeling the algebraic rules. After the assigned group has presented, ask if the other participants saw any other ways to physically model the rules and have them demonstrate also. Ask the following with each activity • What does the ordered pair ( , ) mean? • Does the ordered pair ( , ) belong to this graph? Why or why not? • Trace to any ordered pair on the function. What meaning, if any, do the coordinates have for the problem situation? Activity 1: Building Blocks This sequence of numbers is known as the square numbers (1, 4, 9, 16, 25,...) and provides a beginning point for identifying dependent quadratic relationships. 1. Sample Process 1 2⋅2 3⋅3 n⋅n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Sample Process 12 22 32 n2 Spring 2001 Sample Process 67 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2. 3. 4. 6. The fifth figure has 5 rows by 6 rows, so there are 5 ⋅ 6 = 30 cubes. 7. Sample Process 1⋅ 2 2⋅3 3⋅ 4 n(n + 1) Sample Process 12 + 1 22 + 2 32 + 3 n2 + n Sample Process 9. Activity 2: Starting Staircases 1. Sample Process Sample Process 1⋅ 2 1 2 2⋅3 1+ 2 2 3⋅ 4 1+ 2 + 3 2 n(n + 1) ? 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Sample Process 1 1 2 1 (2 ) − 2 (2 ) 2 1 2 1 (3 ) − 2 (3) 2 1 2 1 n − n 2 2 68 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2. 3. A base of 15 means the 15th triangular number so it has 15(15 + 1) = 120 blocks. 2 4. For a similar triangle with 36 blocks, the figure number is 8. 6. Sample Process Sample Process Sample Process 2 + 2(1) 2⋅2 3 + 2(3) 3⋅3 4 + 2(6) 4⋅4 2 n(n + 1) (n + 1) (n + 1) + 2 2 Flip the blocks in the back up on top to make a square of n+1 dimensions. The center column plus 2 triangular numbers. 8. Activity 3: Too Many Triangles Note that TI has a Sierpinski triangle program in the manual. Sample Process 1 1⋅ 3 1⋅ 3 ⋅ 3 1 ⋅ 3n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Sample Process Spring 2001 69 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Leaders' Notes 2. 3. 4. We do not have the expectation that participants should solve this algebraically. We want participants to understand that the exponential model is accessible to algebra students when approached numerically and graphically and later symbolically. We spend more time on the exponential model at the end of the institute. 6. Sample Process 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 4 4 n 1 1 4 Sample Process 8. Wrap it up: • Refer to the linear patterns in the previous activities. Do we have quantities here that are the “changing quantity” and the “fixed quantity” in these patterns? [No, not like the linear patterns. The patterns here are a little different. We do have a “starting” point (y-intercept, the y-value when x = 0 .] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 70 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Leaders' Notes • What about slope? [The main idea we want to get across here is that the slope is not constant. The rate of change is changing. Constant rate of change, constant slope means linear relationship. Changing rate of change means non-linear.] Draw triangles on the graphs to demonstrate that the rate of change is not constant (the triangles are changing—for every constant change in x, the change is y is different.) Math Note: Participants may note that for the linear and quadratic patterns, the term number started with 1, but for the exponential patterns, the term number started with 0. These ideas will be further explored in the Linear section and the Exponential Activities. Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1a. All of the tables in 2.1 Identifying Patterns can be produced recursively using repeated addition. b. The graphs of repeated addition are linear. 2a. The two tables in Activity 3 in 2.2 Identifying More Patterns can be produced recursively using repeated multiplication. b. The graphs of repeated multiplication are not linear. They are exponential. Summary: By using concrete models and the process column, participants model nonlinear patterns. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 71 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 1 Activity 1: Building Blocks Suppose you are building square arrays out of cubes, as shown below. Use the table to find the relationship between the number of blocks needed for each figure and the dimension of the square array. Term Number Visual Written (dimension (figure) Description of square array) 1 A 1 by 1 square has 1 cube. 2 Process Column Numerical Value of Term (number of blocks) 1 4 3 4 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 72 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 1 1. Use the process column to write a function that expresses the relationship between the term number and the number of cubes. 2. Graph the data from your table on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator. What is a reasonable domain for this situation? A reasonable range? 3. What figure number will have 25 cubes? What is this ordered pair on the graph? 4. How many cubes do you need for the 25th term? What is this ordered pair on the graph? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 73 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 1 5. Suppose you add an extra column of cubes to the figures above. Use your cubes to build the first four figures and record the data below. Term Number Visual Written Description Process Column Numerical Value of Term 1 2 3 4 n 6. Write a rule in words to describe how to find the total number of cubes for the fifth figure. 7. Write a rule in symbols that expresses the relationship between the total number of cubes and the term number. 8. Predict how the graph of this data differs from the graph of the original data. Explain. 9. Graph the above data on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator and compare to the previous graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 74 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 2 Activity 2: Starting Staircases Suppose you are building the triangular numbers from cubes, based on the pattern below. Use the table to find the relationship between the number of blocks and the term number. Term Number 1 Visual Written Description The 1st staircase needs 1 block. 2 Process Column Numerical Value of Term 1 3 3 4 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 75 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 2 1. Use the process column to write a function that expresses the relationship between the total number of blocks and the term number. 2. Graph the data from your table on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator. What is a reasonable domain for this situation? A reasonable range? 3. Use words to describe how to use blocks to build a similar staircase with a base of 15 blocks. What is this ordered pair on the graph? 4. If a similar staircase has 36 blocks, what is the figure number? What is this ordered pair on the graph? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 76 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 2 5. Suppose the figures are as shown. Use your cubes to build the first three figures and record the data below. Term Number Visual Written Description Process Column Numerical Value of Term (number of blocks) 1 2 3 4 n 6. Write a rule for this new data that expresses the relationship between the total number of blocks and the term number. 7. Predict how the graph of this data differs from the graph of the original data. Explain. 8. Graph the above data on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator and compare to the previous graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 77 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 3 Activity 3: Too Many Triangles Suppose you are drawing the fractal, based on the pattern below. Use the table to find the relationship between the number of upward triangles and the term number. Term Number 0 1 Visual Written Description One new upward triangle Three new upward triangles Process Column Numerical Value of Term (number of new upward triangles) 1 3 2 3 4 n TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 78 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 3 1. Use the process column to write a function that expresses the relationship between the number of new upward triangles and the term number. 2. Graph the data from your table on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator. What is a reasonable domain for this situation? A reasonable range? Explain. 3. Find the total number of new triangles for term number 8. 4. If there are a total of 2187 new upward triangles, what term number is this? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 79 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Activity 3 5. Now consider the area of one of the smallest triangles in each figure and record the data below. Numerical Value of Term Written Process Visual Term (area Number Description Column of smallest triangle) 0 1 The area of the smallest triangle is 1 unit The area of one of the smallest triangles is 1 of a unit 4 1 1 4 2 3 n 6. Write a rule for this new data that expresses the relationship between the area of one of the smallest triangles and the term number. 7. Predict how the graph of this data differs from the graph of the original data. Explain. 8. Graph the above data on 1” graph paper and/or create a scatter plot on a graphing calculator and compare to the previous graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 80 I. Foundations for Functions 2.2 Identifying More Patterns: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Refer to the tables in 2.1 Identifying Patterns. a. Look at the column “Numerical Value of Term.” What operation when applied to a term produces the next term? In other words, what is happening recursively? b. What kind of graph does this repeated operation produce? 2. Refer to the tables in Too Many Triangles. a. Look at the column “Numerical Value of Term.” What operation when applied to a term produces the next term? In other words, what is happening recursively? b. What kind of graph does this repeated operation produce? 3. Reflect on the activity. How might you adapt the activity to use with your students? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 81 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs Overview: Participants use motion detectors to investigate distance over time graphs. This lays the groundwork for graph reading and for work with rates of change. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.2.C) The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. Terms: rate of change, increasing, decreasing, constant Materials: motion detector connected to an overhead calculator, motion detectors, data collection devices, graphing calculators, 2 or 3 transparencies cut-to-fit on the overhead calculator screen Procedures: This activity is done in an open area with room for participants to move about in groups of 2 – 4. Have participants complete the Student Activity: Walk This Way. As you do the whole group introduction, sketch two of the walks of the participants. Do this by placing a transparency, cut to fit, on the overhead calculator screen and then sketch the walk with a transparency marker. We will use these sketches of walks at the end of Activity 2. Math Note: Scientific convention is to write y versus x when referring to a situation of (x, y). In other words, the dependent variable is always listed first, then the independent variable as in: dependent variable versus independent variable. Thus, this activity refers to Distance versus Time graphs or Distance over Time graphs, where time is the independent variable and distance is the dependent variable. Activity 1: Walking Graphs Have participants answer the questions in their groups. Circulate and answer questions. Ask a member of each group to present an answer for one of the Exercises. Answers will vary. Sample answers: 1. The y-intercept of the first segment is the distance away from the motion detector at time = 0. This tells you where to start walking. 2. The x-axis represents time and each tick mark represents a second. The number of tick marks on the x-axis represents the time to walk for each segment. 3. If the segment decreases as time increases on the x-axis, then the distance from the motion detector is decreasing. This means you should walk toward the motion detector. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 82 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes 4. If the segment increases as time increases on the x-axis, then the distance from the motion detector is increasing. This means you should walk away from the motion detector. 5. If the segment decreased or increased slowly (it was shallow), then that means that the distance from the motion detector was changing slowly as time increased. Therefore, you should walk slowly. 6. If the segment decreased or increased rapidly (it was steep), then that means that the distance from the motion detector was changing rapidly as time increased. Therefore, you should walk quickly. 7. If the segment was horizontal, then that means that the distance from the motion detector was not changing as time increased. The distance was remaining constant. Therefore you should stand still. Put up the transparency of the student activity: Practice Walking Linear Graphs. Draw triangles on some of the line segments to show that each line segment has a constant rate of change, that for every increment in the xdirection, the segment increases or decreases by the same amount in the ydirection. Do not spend too much time here. Simply demonstrate that for a given line segment, triangles drawn as shown with equal bases are congruent. This means that the heights are equal. In the next activity, we will contrast these constant rates of change with non-constant rates of change of non-linear graphs. Activity 2: Walking More Graphs In this activity, participants walk non-linear graphs. Have participants collect data for about 4 seconds. (This may necessitate collecting the data not in realtime. If participants prefer to collect data in real-time (seeing the data as they collect it), simply have participants ignore the tick marks on the x-axis and collect data for 15 seconds. Discuss the advantages and disadvantages of both methods. In real time, participants can quickly adjust their motion in the middle of data collection. However, that may mean that they do not analyze and plan carefully first. Out of real time, participants must analyze and plan carefully. Then after obtaining the resulting graph, they adjust the plan and walk again. The big idea in the activity is to get a feel for changing rates of change, therefore the exact starting and stopping points are less important then the general shape of the graph. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 83 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes Have participants do the activity and answer the questions in their groups. Circulate and help. Ask a member of each group to present an answer for one of the Exercises. Answers will vary. Sample answers: 1. Start 6 feet from the motion detector. Stand still for less than a second. Start walking toward the motion detector slowly at first and then speeding up over 4 seconds. 2. Start about 2.5 feet from the motion detector. Start walking away quickly, slowing down over 4 seconds to a dead stop at the end. 3. Start about 2 feet from the motion detector. Start walking away slowly, speeding up over 4 seconds. 4. Start about 6 feet from the motion detector. Start walking toward the motion detector quickly, slowing down over 4 seconds to a dead stop at the end. 5. Start about 6 feet from the motion detector. Start walking toward the motion detector quickly, slowing down over 2 seconds, stop briefly, then walk away from the motion detector slowly, speeding up till the end of the four seconds. 6. Start about 2 feet from the motion detector. Start walking away from the motion detector quickly, slowing down over 2 seconds, stop briefly, then walk toward the motion detector slowly, speeding up till the end of the four seconds. 7. You know to speed up (accelerate) when the curve gets steeper, when the change in y over an increment in x is greater than it was before. 8. You know to slow down (decelerate) when the curve gets less steep, when the change in y over an increment in x is less than it was before. 9. e, f, g. These graphs show walking at a constant rate because the change in the y-direction is constant for a constant change in the x-direction. The rate of change is constant. For the horizontal line, the rate of change is a constant zero. Draw triangles to illustrate. For every change in x , the change in y is zero! TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 84 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes 10. a,c. These graphs show a walker speeding up because the change in y is increasing over a constant change in x. The rate of change is increasing. Draw triangles to illustrate. You can also draw tangent lines to illustrate that the slopes of the tangent lines (the instantaneous rate of change at the point of tangency) are increasing. 11. b,d. These graphs show a walker slowing down because the change in y is decreasing over a constant change in x. The rate of change is decreasing. Draw triangles to illustrate. You can also draw tangent lines to illustrate that the slopes of the tangent lines (the instantaneous rate of change at the point of tangency) are decreasing. 12. e. As shown above, the rate of change for a horizontal line is a constant zero. The walker is standing still because for every change in x, the change is y is a constant zero. The distance from the motion detector is not changing. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 85 I. Foundations for Functions • 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes Can you produce a vertical line by walking in front of a motion detector? [No, a vertical line suggests that at one instant in time, the walker is at an infinite number of locations, every point on that line. A walker can only be one distance from the motion detector at a time.] Wrap up these activities as a whole group using the sketches of participants’ walks on the cut-to-fit transparencies from the beginning. Put a sketch on a cut-to-fit transparency on the overhead calculator. (Consider using a walk that has varied sections, linear and non-linear.) Ask participants to discuss in their groups, how a walker should walk to reproduce the walk. Randomly choose a group’s description and have a walker walk the description to confirm. Repeat if desired. Sample Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. I started jogging away from my house (when I was 0.5 kilometers from my house) and I gradually sped up to a sprint. At 15 minutes (tick marks are at 5 minute increments), I fell on the ground, 4 kilometers from my house. I sat there for about 20 minutes, catching my breath. I then started gradually back home, speeding up as I went until I was again sprinting in the door. 2. I walked from my locker to my class over two minutes. I stood there chatting for a minute until I realized I had left my book in my friend’s locker. I walked quickly to my friend’s locker, which was thankfully open, grabbed the book and started quickly back to class. But I ran into the principal who walked me back to class, slowing down as we went, because the principal was talking to me about an upcoming event. Summary: The big idea here is that walking at a constant rate produces a linear distance over time graph. The rate of change of a line is constant. Speeding up or slowing down, non-constant rates of change, produce non-linear distance over time graphs. The rates of change are changing. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 86 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Activity 1 Activity 1: Walking Graphs Answer the following questions based on your experiences in the Student Activity: Walk This Way. 1. How did you know where to start walking for each graph? 2. How did you know how long to walk for each segment? 3. How did you know when to walk toward the motion detector? Use the words “time” and “distance” in your answer. 4. How did you know when to walk away from the motion detector? Use the words “time” and “distance” in your answer. 5. How did you know when to walk slowly? 6. How did you know when to walk quickly? 7. How did you know when to stand still? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 87 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Activity 2 Activity 2: Walking More Graphs distance distance Practice walking the following graphs using a motion detector and a graphing calculator. Describe the walk that you used to produce each graph. time 2. distance distance 1. time time 4. distance distance 3. time time 5. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond time 6. Spring 2001 88 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Activity 2 7. How did you know when to speed up? 8. How did you know when to slow down? Which graph(s) below show: 9. a constant rate? Why? 10. a walker speeding up? Why? 11. a walker slowing down? Why? 12. a walker standing still? Why? b. a. e. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond c. f. d. g. Spring 2001 89 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Make up a story for the following graphs of distance over time. Distance over Time 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Distance over Time 2. Spring 2001 90 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Student Activity Student Activity: Walk This Way Overview: This is an introduction to graphs of motion data, specifically linear data. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.2.C) The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. Terms: rate of change Materials: motion detector connected to a viewscreen calculator, a motion detector with graphing calculator for each group of 3-4 students, and data collection devices Procedures: Often students are asked to interpret distance over time graphs. In this activity, students experience seeing many examples quickly of their own motion graphed over time. Students gain intuition for interpreting graphs as they make connections between their own motion and the graphs of their motion. The classroom should be set up with an aisle down the middle. Set up a motion detector pointing down the aisle, connected to a viewscreen calculator, so the class can see both the students walking down the aisle and the data projected from the calculator on a screen in front of the room. Explain that the motion detector sends out an ultrasonic pulse. The pulse bounces off the walker, and the motion detector records the distance at that time. The calculator displays the data as a graph with the distance measured in meters and the time measured in seconds. Run the CBR Ranger program or a similar program. Use the following screens to set up the experiment, and then follow the instructions on the screen. Ask a few students to walk one at a time in front of the motion detector. Encourage students to walk differently - slowly, quickly, standing still, toward the motion detector, away from the motion detector, etc. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 91 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Student Activity After each walk, discuss the following: • What does the starting point represent? • What does a fast walk look like? • What does a slow walk look like? • What does a pause look like? • What does it look like when you walk away from the motion detector or toward the motion detector? • Discuss a “straight” verses a “curved” graph. Point out that for constant rates of change, we use a linear model to model the data. Activity: Practice Walking Linear Graphs Each group of 3 – 4 students will practice walking different linear graphs using a motion detector and a graphing calculator. First Time: Hold the motion detector and the calculator. Point the motion detector at the wall and practice walking the graphs. Second Time: Have the group hold the motion detector and calculator. Point the motion detector at one person in the group. As a group, instruct the walker on how to walk the graph. Extension: Have each group come to the front and match a graph. Give the group a minute to discuss. Then a member of the group walks to match the graph. Have the rest of the class rate the group using the following rubric. Have the class rate the group quickly using a show of fingers. Choose the mode for each rating to get a quick score for the team. Starting Point: (1 – 5) Did the walker start at the correct point? Rate: (1 – 5) Did the walker walk at the correct rate? Direction: (1 – 5) Did the walker walk in the correct direction? Accuracy: (1 – 5) Was the rate correct but the distance was incorrect? Teamwork: (1 – 5) Did the group work as a team well? Assessment: Linear Motion. Now your students should be able to complete the Assessment. Note that this assessment is intended to provide teachers with sample assessment items. It is not intended as a stand-alone worksheet or quiz. Teachers can use the items as a starting point for creating meaningful assessments. Answers: 1. B 2. C 3. A 4 – 7. Answers will vary. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 92 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Student Activity Sample answers: 8. 9. 10. 11. Note: this activity was adapted from an activity in the Mathematical Modeling Institute for Secondary Teachers. Summary: Through experience, students learn intuitive notions about distance over time graphs. Starting points (y-intercepts), rates of change, direction, and time intervals are among the ideas that are built. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 93 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Student Activity Activity: Practice Walking Graphs Practice walking the following graphs using a motion detector. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 94 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Student Activity Assessment: Linear Motion Match the description with the graph. a. b. c. _____ 1. Start one meter away from the motion detector. Walk slowly away from the motion detector for about 3 seconds, stand still for about 4 seconds, and then walk quickly away from the motion detector for about 3 seconds. _____ 2. Start 3 meters away from the motion detector, and walk away from it at a moderate rate for about 3 seconds. Stand still for about 4 seconds, and then walk quickly toward the motion detector for 3 seconds. _____ 3. Start 2 meters away from the motion detector, and walk toward it at a moderate rate for about 3 seconds. Stand still for about 4 seconds, and then walk toward the motion detector at about the same moderate rate as earlier for about 3 seconds. Write a description for a walk that would produce each of these graphs. 4. ____________________ _______________________ 5. ___________________________ ______________________________ 6. ____________________ _______________________ 7. ___________________________ ______________________________ TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 95 I. Foundations for Functions 3.1 Interpreting Distance versus Time Graphs: Student Activity Sketch a graph that would match the description. 8. Start 4.5 meters from the motion detector, and walk quickly toward it for 2.5 seconds. Walk slowly toward the motion detector for 3 seconds. Walk even more slowly away from the motion detector for 4.5 seconds. 9. Start 0.5 meters from the motion detector. Walk slowly away from the motion detector for 5 seconds. Walk extremely slowly away from the motion detector for 2 seconds. Walk quickly away from the motion detector for 3 seconds. 10. Start one meter from the motion detector and stand still for 2 seconds. Walk away from the motion detector quickly for 5 seconds. Walk back slowly toward the motion detector for 3 seconds. 11. Start 3 meters from the motion detector, and walk slowly away from it for 3 seconds. Stand still for 4 seconds. Walk quickly toward the motion detector for 3 seconds. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 96 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs Overview: Participants use motion detectors to investigate velocity over time graphs. This continues to build graph-reading skills and to build understanding for rates of change. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.2.C) The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. Terms: velocity, speed, direction, rate of change Materials: motion detector connected to an overhead calculator, motion detectors, data collection devices, graphing calculators Procedures: Set up the room similarly to the Student Activity: Walk This Way, with a motion detector connected to an overhead calculator. The room should have an aisle down the middle in front of the motion detector. Set up the motion detector to display velocity data, collecting data for 4 seconds. • What is velocity? [Speed and direction.] • What are some common units for speed? [miles per hour, feet per second, meters per sec, kilometers per hour, etc.] • How will a graph of velocity over time differ than a graph of distance over time? [Do not answer at this point.] Have a volunteer walk the following instructions. Collect data for about 4 seconds. Before you display each graph, have participants sketch a prediction of the graph. After each walk, discuss the resulting graph, using the questions following each instruction. 1: Start 1.5 feet away from the motion detector. Stand still briefly when the data collection starts, then walk away slowly, speeding up as you go. Repeat if necessary. • What does x represent? [elapsed time] • What does y represent? [the speed of the walker] • Why does the graph increase? [As time increased, the speed of the walker increased.] Trace to a value on the graph as shown. • What is the meaning of the coordinates shown? [After about 1.8 seconds, I was moving at 0.2 meters per second away from the motion detector.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 97 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes 2: Start behind the motion detector. Walk past the motion detector and start the data collection when you are about 1.5 feet in front of it. Continue to walk away, slowing down as you go to a complete stop by the end of the time. Repeat if necessary. • • • What does x represent? [elapsed time] What does y represent? [the speed of the walker] Why does the graph decrease? [As time increased, the speed of the walker decreased.] Trace to a value on the graph as shown. • What is the meaning of the coordinates shown? [After about 1 second, I was moving at 0.5 meters per second away from the motion detector.] 3: Start about 10 feet from the motion detector. Stand still briefly when the data collection starts, then walk toward the motion detector slowly, speeding up as you go. Repeat if necessary. • • • • What does x represent? [elapsed time] What does y represent? [the speed of the walker] Why does the graph increase? [As time increased, the speed of the walker increased.] Why is the graph in the fourth quadrant? [Velocity is speed and direction. The negative y-values indicate that the walker was moving toward the motion detector. The magnitude of the y-values indicate the rate, the speed. Magnitude is the same as the absolute value of the number.] Trace to a value on the graph as shown. • What is the meaning of the coordinates shown? [After about 2 seconds, I was moving at 0.3 meters per second toward the motion detector.] 4: Start about 15 feet from the motion detector, walking quickly toward the motion detector, and begin the data collection when you are about 10 feet in front of it. Continue to walk toward the motion detector, slowing down as you go. Repeat if necessary. • • • What does x represent? [elapsed time] What does y represent? [the speed of the walker] Why does the graph decrease? [As time increased, the speed of the walker decreased.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 98 I. Foundations for Functions • 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes Why is the graph in the fourth quadrant? [Velocity is speed and direction. The negative y-values indicate that the walker was moving toward the motion detector. The magnitude of the y-values indicate the rate, the speed. Magnitude is the same as the absolute value of the number.] Trace to a value on the graph as shown. • What is the meaning of the coordinates shown? [After about 2.3 seconds, I was moving at 0.34 meters per second toward the motion detector.] 5: Start right at the motion detector. Walk away from the motion detector at a constant rate. Begin the data collection when you are at least 1.5 feet from the motion detector or when you are walking at a constant rate. Continue to walk at a constant rate until time is up. Repeat if necessary. • • What does x represent? [elapsed time] What does y represent? [the speed of the walker] Trace to a value on the graph as shown. • What is the meaning of the coordinates shown? [After about 2.3 seconds, I was moving at 0.34 meters per second toward the motion detector.] • Why is the graph so wavy? Was the rate not constant? [Trace on the graph and note that the values are really quite close together, but the window is probably very small, which exaggerates small changes in the y-values. Change the window as shown below and note that the graph now looks quite constant.] Math Note: Velocity is speed and direction. The speed is represented by the magnitude of the velocity. The direction is represented by the sign of the TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 99 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes velocity. If the velocity at time t is –4, then −4 = 4 is the speed at time t and the direction is toward the motion detector. If the velocity at time t is 6, then 6 = 6 is the speed and the direction is away from the motion detector. When discussing direction and velocity, remind participants of the direction implied in a different measure of motion, acceleration. The force of ft m or −9.8 . The value of acceleration due to gravity is −32 2 sec sec 2 acceleration is negative which means that the object is falling toward the earth, just as the negative in velocity means that the walker is walking toward the motion detector. Activity 1: Matching Velocity Graphs Have participants do the activity in groups of 3 – 4, by walking the graphs and then answering the questions. Ask a member of each group to present an answer for one of the Exercises. Answers will vary. Sample answers: 1. The y-values stand for velocity so when the y-values have small magnitudes, then the rate is slower. Therefore, you should walk slower. 2. The y-values stand for velocity so when the y-values have large magnitudes, then the rate is faster. Therefore, you should walk faster. 3. Since the y-values stand for velocity, when the graph decreases in the first quadrant, then the velocity should decrease, or in other words, you should slow down. In the fourth quadrant, when the graph increases, then the velocity is decreasing (because the magnitude is getting smaller) and you should slow down. 4. Since the y-values stand for velocity, when the graph increases in the first quadrant, then the velocity should increase, or in other words, you should speed up. In the fourth quadrant, when the graph decreases, then the velocity is increasing (because the magnitude is getting larger) and you should speed up. 5. Points in the first quadrant have positive y-values. In this case, the positive velocity means that you were walking away from the motion detector. 6. Points in the fourth quadrant have negative y-values. In this case, the negative velocity means that you were walking toward the motion detector. 7. Since the y-values stand for velocity, points along the x-axis have y-values of zero and therefore, the velocity is zero. Therefore, you should stop. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 100 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes 8. You don’t know where to start! You need to start where ever you will have enough room to do what you need to do. If you need to move toward the motion detector, you had better start a ways in front of it. If you need to move away from the motion detector, you probably ought to start closer to it. Activity 2: Connecting Distance and Velocity Graphs Do Exercise 1 together as a whole group. Ask a volunteer to follow the instructions and first display the distance graph. In order to see both the distance and the velocity graphs at the same time, do the following. Put an overhead transparency on the overhead calculator screen and sketch the distance over time graph. Place this transparency on another overhead projector. Now display the velocity graph on the viewscreen calculator. With both graphs displayed simultaneously, label them as follows, based on the questions on the activity page. 1. standing still slowing down slower rate quicker rate slowing down quicker rate standing still speeding up speeding up slower rate 2. quicker rate quicker rate standing still slowing down speeding up slower rate slower rate standing still speeding up slowing down Note: This activity provides participants with intuitive experience in the calculus and physics concepts of a function (a position function) and the function’s derivative (a velocity function). However, the main idea of this TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 101 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Leaders’ Notes activity in the Algebra I Institute is to use the graphs of participant’s own motion to build the skills of reading, interpreting, and analyzing graphs. If participants request that you help them connect these experiences with their previous experiences in calculus and physics, then briefly help them make those connections if you wish. Do not suggest that the participants are to teach calculus and physics in an algebra I course. Answers for Reflect and Apply: Sample Answers: Distance over Time: In PE one day, students were running on the basketball court. They started at the free throw line and jogged to the end of the court. Then they stood there and took a breather. Then they sprinted back the whole length of the court. Velocity over Time: In PE one day, students were running on the basketball court. They were already jogging, and when the time keeper said, “Go,” they sped up to a sprint. They sprinted for a bit and then they slowed down (faster than they had sped up) until they came to a stop. Ask participants to recall the Reflect and Apply Exercises from 1.1.1 Variables and Functions. • Do you think students would complete these Exercises differently after the graphing experiences in this Activity? Summary: The big idea here is to build intuition for interpreting graphs. With the use of technology, participants get instant feedback on distance and velocity graphs and can see many examples rapidly. They can monitor and adjust quickly to gain added understanding. By comparing a distance graph for a situation with a velocity graph of the same situation, participants make valuable connections between distance and velocity and about analyzing graphs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 102 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Activity 1 Activity 1: Matching Velocity Graphs Practice walking the following graphs using a motion detector and a graphing calculator. Describe the walk that you used to produce each graph. a. b. (0, 0) Time c. (0, 0) Time (0, 0) Time d. (0, 0) Time e. Time (0, 0) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 103 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Activity 1 1. How did you know when to walk slowly? 2. How did you know when to walk quickly? 3. How did you know when to slow down? 4. How did you know when to speed up? 5. How did you know when to walk away from the motion detector? 6. How did you know when to walk toward the motion detector? 7. How did you know when to stop? 8. How did you know where to start walking for each graph? 9. How did you know what speed to start walking? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 104 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Activity 2 Activity 2: Connecting Distance and Velocity Graphs Read the following directions and sketch your prediction of the resulting graphs. Then collect the data (for about 4 seconds.) 1. Start about 1.5 feet in front of the motion detector and walk away quickly for about 2 seconds. Stand still for 1 second and then walk toward the motion detector slowly for the remaining time. Predict : b. Velocity versus Time a. Distance versus Time The actual results: c. Distance versus Time d. Velocity versus Time Label the following sections in the graphs above: A. The walker is standing still. B. The walker is slowing down. C. The walker is speeding up. D. The walker is traveling at a quicker rate. E. The walker is traveling at a slower rate. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 105 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Activity 2 2. Start about 5 feet in front of the motion detector and walk toward the motion detector slowly for about 1 second. Stand still for 1 second and then walk away from the motion detector quickly for the remaining time. Predict : a. Distance versus Time b. Velocity versus Time The actual results: c. Distance versus Time d. Velocity versus Time Label the following sections in the graphs above: A. The walker is standing still. B. The walker is slowing down. C. The walker is speeding up. D. The walker is traveling at a quicker rate. E. The walker is traveling at a slower rate. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 106 I. Foundations for Functions 3.2 Interpreting Velocity versus Time Graphs: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Make up two different stories based on the graph below. One story should be based on the graph representing distance over time. The other story should be based on the graph representing velocity over time. Story for distance versus time: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Story for velocity versus time: Spring 2001 107 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Leaders’ Notes 1.1 The Linear Parent Function Overview: Using contextual situations, participants investigate the linear parent function, y = x. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.2.A) The student identifies and sketches the general forms of linear ( y = x ) and quadratic ( y = x 2 ) parent functions. (b.2.C) The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. Terms: input, output Materials: colored pencils or pens, pieces of flat spaghetti, graphing calculators, program ACTSCRS Procedures: Because of the role of the line y = x as the linear parent function, we begin our work with linear functions using contextual situations to develop intuitive notions about the line y = x . Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Complete the Student Activity, Age Estimates, with participants. Talk through the assessment. Talk through the Student Activity, Sales Goals, with participants. Activity 1: ACT Scores Have participants run the program ACTSCRS. The program stores the data on Transparency 1 into five lists in the calculator. Create the indicated scatter plots and graph the line y = x , finding appropriate windows to be able to see the comparisons. Sample General Statements: 1. Most states have higher mean Mathematics scores than that state’s mean English scores. 2. Most states have higher mean Reading scores than that state’s mean Mathematics scores. 3. Most states have higher mean Sci Reasoning scores than that state’s mean Mathematics scores. 4. Most states have higher mean Composite scores than that state’s mean Mathematics scores. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 108 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Leaders’ Notes Sample Scatter Plots: English versus Mathematics Reading versus Mathematics 23.0 23.0 21.0 21.0 19.0 19.0 17.0 17.0 17.0 19.0 21.0 17.0 23.0 Mathematics 21.0 23.0 Mathematics Sci Reasoning versus Mathematics Composite versus Mathematics 23.0 23.0 21.0 21.0 19.0 19.0 17.0 17.0 19.0 17.0 19.0 21.0 23.0 17.0 19.0 21.0 23.0 Mathematics Mathematics There is other comparative information about ACT scores at http://www.act.org/news/data/99/99data.html • • • Did any of the results surprise you? How did you use the line y = x to make general statements about the scores? What are some of the factors that may influence the results? [Some states have large populations of students who take the ACT, where there are other states whose student populations primarily take the SAT. In those SAT states, why might students choose to take the TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 109 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Leaders’ Notes ACT? Perhaps those students are desiring to go out of state, looking for specific scholarships, or going to private schools.] Is it true that the higher the mathematics score, the higher the other test score tend to be? In other words, is there a positive correlation between math scores and the other scores? [Yes] • Activity 2: Temperatures In the Student Activity and Activity 1, participants explore data in the first quadrant, comparing the data to the line y = x . In this activity, participants will explore data in all 4 quadrants, using average temperatures around the world. Have participants work in groups to complete the activity. Ask a group to present their results. Use Transparency 3: World Map to determine the location of indicated places. Note that for places north of the equator seasons are opposite of those south of the equator. Below find the average temperatures used to make the graph. Place 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 July ( C ˚ ) 35 28.5 14 13 10.2 -11 -57 -0.4 Austin, TX Detroit, MI Siberia Santiago, Argentina Nome, Alaska Greenland icecap Antarctica Butlers Gorge, Australia December (C˚) 16.7 1.8 -14 26.9 -13.9 -47 -18 5.4 Average Temperatures (C˚) in Selected Locations 60 40 4 1 20 8 -60 -40 -20 2 0 -20 7 6 20 40 60 5 3 -40 -60 Average July Temperatures (C˚) • How many points are in the second quadrant? [One] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 110 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Leaders’ Notes • • Describe the place that would have a point in the third quadrant. [The place would have both a cold average July temperature (below freezing) and a cold average December temperature (below freezing). The place with the colder July temperature would need to be in the southern hemisphere, our example is Antarctica. The place with the colder December temperature would need to be in the northern hemisphere, our example is the Greenland icecap.] Describe the place that would have a point in the second quadrant. [The place would have a cold average July temperature (below freezing) and a warmer average December temperature. Thus, it would need to be in the southern hemisphere, our example is Butler’s Gorge, Australia.] Activity 3: Symbolic Have participants work in groups to complete the activity. Ask a group to present their results. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. A, B, C, K, L E, F, G, H, I D, J A, G Any point in the second quadrant, points in the first quadrant above the line y = x , points in the third quadrant above the line y = x . 6. Any point in the fourth quadrant, points in the first quadrant below the line y = x , points in the third quadrant below the line y = x . 7. Points on the line y = x . 8. Points on the line y = − x . • • In what ways have the concrete problem situations in the Activity changed the way you approached these symbolic questions? In what ways can experience with similar concrete problem situations aid students in their understanding of similar symbolic questions? Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. The walker is moving at about 1 foot per second. 2. From 0 to 1 seconds, 4 to 5 seconds, 5 to 6 seconds 3. From 1 to 2 seconds, 2 to 3 seconds, 7 to 8 seconds Summary: The line y = x is the parent function for the linear function family. In this activity we build intuition for the line y = x as an important starting point for work with linear functions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 111 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Transparency 1 Transparency 1: ACT Scores by State 1999 State Name Alabama Alaska Arizona Arkansas California Colorado Connecticut Delaware Florida Georgia Hawaii Idaho Illinois Indiana Iowa Kansas Kentucky Louisiana Maine Maryland Massachusetts Michigan Minnesota Mississippi Missouri Montana Nebraska Nevada New Hampshire English Math Reading 20.3 20.1 20.7 20.6 20.5 20.9 21.2 19.7 20.0 19.3 20.3 20.7 20.9 20.6 21.5 21.0 19.9 19.7 21.4 20.2 21.7 20.6 21.4 18.8 21.3 20.9 21.3 20.7 21.7 19.5 21.0 21.4 19.2 21.9 21.1 21.7 20.1 20.5 20.0 22.7 20.8 21.4 20.9 21.6 21.0 19.3 18.9 21.8 20.9 22.0 21.1 22.0 17.9 20.9 21.2 21.4 21.3 22.0 20.5 21.7 21.9 20.7 21.5 21.9 21.8 21.1 21.0 20.3 21.5 22.1 21.6 21.7 22.2 21.9 20.6 19.7 22.8 21.3 22.5 21.5 22.4 18.9 22.0 22.5 21.9 22.1 23.0 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Sci Reasoning 19.9 21.1 21.2 20.1 20.8 21.7 21.1 20.4 20.5 20.0 21.4 21.4 21.3 21.2 22.1 21.4 20.2 19.5 21.8 20.8 21.4 21.5 22.3 18.6 21.5 21.9 21.7 21.4 21.7 Composite 20.2 21.1 21.4 20.3 21.3 21.5 21.6 20.5 20.6 20.0 21.6 21.4 21.4 21.2 22.0 21.5 20.1 19.6 22.1 20.9 22.0 21.3 22.1 18.7 21.6 21.8 21.7 21.5 22.2 112 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Transparency 2 Transparency 2: ACT Scores by State 1999 (cont.) New Jersey New Mexico New York North Carolina North Dakota Ohio Oklahoma Oregon Pennsylvania Rhode Island South Carolina South Dakota Tennessee Texas Utah Vermont Virginia Washington Washington, DC West Virginia Wisconsin Wyoming 20.1 19.5 20.8 18.6 20.6 20.8 20.4 21.8 20.8 22.5 18.6 20.5 19.8 19.7 21.0 21.3 20.2 21.9 18.0 20.1 21.6 20.7 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 20.8 19.5 22.2 19.4 21.2 21.1 19.8 22.1 21.2 22.3 19.0 20.9 19.1 20.2 20.7 21.5 20.4 22.2 18.8 19.0 22.2 20.9 20.9 20.7 22.2 19.6 21.7 21.9 21.0 23.5 21.9 23.4 19.3 21.5 20.4 20.6 22.0 22.7 21.0 23.4 18.7 20.9 22.4 22.0 Spring 2001 20.4 20.3 22.2 19.5 21.6 21.4 20.5 22.4 21.3 21.9 19.2 21.5 19.8 20.4 21.3 21.8 20.4 22.3 18.5 20.3 22.4 21.6 20.7 20.1 22.0 19.4 21.4 21.4 20.6 22.6 21.4 22.7 19.1 21.2 19.9 20.3 21.4 21.9 20.6 22.6 18.6 20.2 22.3 21.4 113 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear P Transparency 3: World Map 6 5 3 2 1 4 7 1 2 Detroit, Michigan 3 4 5 Nome, Alaska 6 Austin, Texas Siberia Santiago, Argentina Greenland 7 Antarctica TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 8 Butler’s Gorge, Australia Spring 2001 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Activity 1 Activity 1: ACT Scores Run the program ACTSCRS. The program stores the following ACT test score data for 1999 for each state in the US and the District of Columbia into lists in your calculator: the mean scores for Mathematics, Reading, English, Sci Reasoning and the mean composite score. • • • • Set up the scatter plots 1 – 4 listed below. Graph the line y = x over each scatter plot. Find windows that will help you compare the scores. Make a general statement about each plot, comparing the two scores. • Identify at least four coordinate pairs to justify your summary. 1. English versus Mathematics 2. Reading versus Mathematics 3. Sci Reasoning versus Mathematics 4. Composite versus Mathematics TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 115 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Activity 2 Activity 2: Temperatures Average Temperatures (C˚) in Selected Locations Average December Temperatures (C˚) 60 40 20 -60 -40 -20 0 20 40 60 -20 -40 -60 Average July Temperatures (C˚) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Austin, Texas Detroit, Michigan Siberia Santiago, Argentina Nome, Alaska Greenland Icecap Antarctica Australia TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 116 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Activity 3 Activity 3: Symbolic For the following points (x, y), choose a point or points that match the description. 1. x < y 2. x > y 3. x = y 4. x = − y B C A D L E F K J I H G Describe where the point (x, y) appears in general when: 5. x < y 6. x > y 7. y = x 8. y = − x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 117 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply The scatter plot represents a walker’s distance from a motion detector. 8 6 4 2 2 4 6 8 Time (sec) 1. Judging by the graph, about how fast do you think the walker was moving? 2. Which one-second interval(s) show the walker moving faster than that rate? 3. Which one-second interval(s) show the walker moving slower than that rate? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 118 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 Student Activity 1: Age Estimates Overview: Students develop intuitive notions about the line y = x . Objective: Algebra I TEKS b.2.a The student identifies and sketches the general forms of linear ( y = x ) and quadratic ( y = x 2 ) parent functions. b.2.c The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. Terms: trend line Materials: colored pencils or pens, pieces of flat spaghetti or brightly colored string, graphing calculator Procedures: Students should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity: How Old? Read 12 names from the list below and ask students to guess the person’s current age, filling in the first and second columns of the table. It is important that you list a variety of ages, from old to young. Have students fill in the third column as you read the actual ages based on the birth dates below. Name Julie Andrews Bill Gates Ronald Reagan George W. Bush Shania Twain LeAnn Rimes Sophia Loren Bill Cosby Britney Spears McCaughey septuplets Jennifer Love Hewitt Jennifer Aniston Charlton Heston Leonardo DiCaprio Harrison Ford Tim Allen Oprah Winfrey Michelle Pfeiffer Michael J. Fox Jodie Foster TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Birthdate 10-01-1935 10-28-1955 02-06-1911 07-06-1946 08-28-1965 08-28-1982 09-20-1934 07-12-1937 12-02-1981 11-19-1997 02-21-1979 02-11-1969 10-04-1924 11-11-1974 07-13-1942 06-12-1953 01-29-1954 04-29-1958 06-09-1961 11-19-1962 Spring 2001 119 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 Ben Affleck Drew Barrymore Frankie Muniz Mary Kate and Ashley Olsen Haley Joel Osment Jonathan Lipnicki 08-15-1972 02-22-1975 12-05-1985 06-13-1986 04-10-1988 10-22-1990 • How well did you guess? • How do you think we could judge if you are a good guesser? • How do you think we could tell if you are an “over” guesser? • How do you think we could tell if you are an “under” guesser? Have students plot the data by hand on the grid and label the axes and a few ordered pairs. Tell students that we want to use a trend line to get a feel for how good they estimate ages. Instruct students to use a piece of spaghetti or string to sketch a trend line for their data. (Use the same color for the trend line as the color of the data points.) Do the same on the transparency of the Activity. Instruct groups to compare their graphs within their group. Based on the graphs: • Who is the better guesser? • Who is more of an “under” guesser? How can you tell? • Who is more of an “over” guesser? How can you tell? Instruct students to use a different color and sketch a “perfect-guess” line, a line that represents perfect guessing. Ask students to write a sentence to describe the perfect-guess line and then translate to symbols. An example: “All my guesses are the same as the actual ages” Guess = Actual G = A or y = x Check that the line students sketched as their “good-guess” line is indeed the line y = x . 2. Have students create a scatter plot (guess, actual). Sample graph: 3. Sample answer: The variable x stands for the guessed age so x min is 0 years and x max is 100 years. The variable y stands for the actual age so ymin is 0 years and y max is 100 years. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 120 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 4. 5. If the student’s points lie mostly above the line, they are an under-guesser. If the student’s points lie mostly below the line, they are an over-guesser. Over or Under Have students complete the activity and then discuss as a group. 1. 50 50 40 40 30 perfect guess 30 20 20 10 10 10 20 30 40 perfect guess 50 10 guess 20 30 40 50 guess 2. Underguess because all of the guesses are smaller when the actual ages are larger. 3. Overguess because all of the guesses are larger when the actual ages are smaller. 4. 50 40 30 20 10 10 guess 20 30 40 50 guess 5. Accept answers between 30 and 40 years old. 6. Accept answers between 20 and 30 years old. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 121 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 7. guess Sample Assessment: 1. You guessed B’s age better. 2. You overguessed C’s age. 3. y = x . 4. [0, 55], [0, 45] 5. The variable x stands for my partner’s guesses of people’s ages, so [0, 40] shows all of the guesses listed. The variable y stands for the actual ages of the people listed, so [0, 45] is a reasonable choice for those ages. This choice allows one to see the origin, which may be helpful in orienting the reader to whether the student is a good age estimator. Note: In this activity students draw trend lines and a “perfect guess” line. The trend lines are approximations or estimates of their guessing, showing the general trend of how they guessed. Refrain from calling trend lines “lines of best fit.” The “perfect guess” line is the line y = x . Summary: The line y = x is the parent function for the linear function family. In this activity intuition for the line y = x is developed as an important starting point for work with linear functions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 122 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 Student Activity 1: How Old? Name Guess (Age) Actual (Age) 1. Sketch a graph of the data. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 123 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 2. Using your data, create a scatter plot on your graphing calculator. Sketch it here. 3. Justify your viewing window choice. 4. Using your calculator, graph the “perfect-guess” line over the scatter plot. 5. Are you an “over-guesser” or an “under-guesser”? Explain. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 124 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 Over or Under? Graph #1 Graph #2 50 50 40 40 30 30 20 20 10 10 10 20 30 40 50 10 guess 20 30 40 50 guess 1. For each graph above, sketch in the “perfect-guess” line, actual = guess, and label it. 2. For graph #1, did the person over-guess or under-guess? Explain. 3. For graph #2, did the person over-guess or under-guess? Explain. 4. For each graph above, sketch a trend line for the data and label it “my trend”. 5. Use your trend line on graph #1. If I guessed an age of 24, what is the actual age of the person? (24, ______) 6. Use your trend line on graph #1. If the person really was 36 years old, what did I probably guess? (______, 36) 7. On the back, create a scatter plot of a person who guessed really well. Label the axes. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 125 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 Sample Assessment 1. Consider A and B. Whose age did you guess better? Why? A B C 2. Did you overestimate or underestimate C’s age? Guess 3. How do you tell your graphing calculator to graph the best guess line, guess = actual ? Your partner had the following guesses. Name Guess Actual Mr. Jackson 50 42 Ms. Chi 42 37 Mr. Beyer 45 40 Ms. Harris 40 28 4. Which would be a good viewing window for a scatter plot of the above data? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 126 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 1 Your partner had the following guesses. Name Guess Mr. King 37 Ms. Alcini 30 Mr. Golm 35 Ms. Cline 25 Actual 42 37 42 30 5. What would be a good viewing window for a scatter plot? Explain each choice. Xmin: Xmax: Ymin: Ymax: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 127 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 2 Student Activity 2: Sales Goals Overview: Students use the context of sales goals to further refine their understanding of the line y = x by contrasting points above and below the line. Objective: Algebra I TEKS b.2.a The student identifies and sketches the general forms of linear ( y = x ) and quadratic ( y = x 2 ) parent functions. b.2.c The student interprets situations in terms of given graphs or creates situations that fit given graphs. Terms: linear parent function Materials: markers, 1” grid paper Procedures: Activity: Sales Goals Begin by orienting students to the graphs using the following discussion questions. The management for a clothing store sets up weekly sales goals for their employees. The graphs show the results for a quarter of a year (12 weeks). Each data point represents a week’s (actual sales, sales goals) for an employee. • What is represented on the x-axis? [Actual sales.] • What is represented on the y-axis? [Sales goals.] • What is the meaning of an ordered pair in this situation? [An ordered pair is (actual sales, sales goals).] • Why might some employees have higher goals set for them? [Some examples may include: more experienced employees, employees with strong sales in the previous quarter, employees that work at peak sales times of the day or week.] • Why do employees have such different levels of goals in the same quarter? [If these graphs represent the second quarter of the year, the goals for the two weeks before Father’s Day would be higher than the week following. The goals for the weeks previous to Easter would be higher than the weeks after Easter.] Pick a specific point on a graph and discuss the meaning. For example, circle the lowest point on Amber’s graph. • What does this point mean for Amber? [Amber set a goal to sell about $2600 for a particular week. She actually sold about $6800, exceeding her goal.] • What are the meanings for the points under the line goals = actual? [The employees exceeded their goals.] • What are the meanings for the points over the line goals = actual? [The employees failed to meet their goals.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 128 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 2 Have students answer the questions on the following page in their groups and sketching their graphs for Exercises 6 – 8 on 1” grid paper. Have students view other groups’ graphs. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enrique and Amber met and exceeded their goals. Seth failed to meet his weekly goals. Moesha most often met her weekly goals. Moesha and Enrique had the higher goals. Seth and Amber had the lower goals. 6. Sample answer: 7. Sample answer: 10000 10000 8000 8000 6000 6000 4000 4000 2000 2000 Actual Sales ($) Actual Sales ($) 8. Sample answers: 10000 10000 8000 8000 6000 6000 4000 4000 2000 2000 Actual Sales ($) Wardrobe consultant with middle goals who often matched the goals. Summary: Actual Sales ($) Wardrobe consultant with middle goals who often failed to meet the goals. Reading and interpreting scatter plots of points above and below the line y = x helps students further refine their understanding of the linear parent function. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 129 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 2 Student Activity 2: Sales Goals A local clothing store sets weekly sales goals for their employees. The graphs below show the quarterly results for four employees, (actual sales, sales goals). Moesha Seth 10000 10000 8000 8000 6000 6000 4000 4000 2000 2000 Actual Sales ($) Actual Sales ($) Enrique Amber 10000 10000 8000 8000 6000 6000 4000 4000 2000 2000 Actual Sales ($) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Actual Sales ($) Spring 2001 130 II. Linear Functions 1.1 The Linear Parent Function: Student Activity 2 1. Which consultant(s) most often met and exceeded their weekly goals? 2. Which consultant(s) most often failed to meet their weekly goals? 3. Which wardrobe consultant(s) most often matched their weekly goals? 4. Which consultant(s) had the higher goals? 5. Which consultant(s) had the lower goals? 6. Sketch a graph of a consultant who has low goals and consistently matched them. 7. Sketch a graph of a consultant who has high goals and did not meet them. 8. Name a scenario that is not represented by the four original graphs or in Exercise 6 and 7 above. Sketch a graph to match the scenario. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 131 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions 1.2 The Y-Intercept Overview: Participants use real life experiences to build the concepts of y-intercept as the starting point and slope as a rate of change. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.1.C) The student translates among and uses algebraic, tabular, graphical, or verbal descriptions of linear functions. (c.2.A) The student develops the concept of slope as rate of change and determines slopes from graphs, tables, and algebraic representations. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. Terms: y-intercept, slope, rate of change, increasing, decreasing, recursion Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Depending on the participants, briefly talk through or work through the Student Activity, which connect recursion with graphing. Activity 1: The Birthday Gift Work through Activity 1 with participants, modeling good pedagogy: ask leading questions, use appropriate wait time, have teachers present their work, etc. Introduce the scenario. 1. Guide participants in filling in the table, using language similar to the following: At time zero, Susan started with $25. Time (weeks) Process Amount Saved 0 $25 $25 After the 1st week, Susan had the $25 she started with and $2.50. Time (weeks) Process Amount Saved 0 $25 $25 $25 + $2.50 1 $27.50 After the 2nd week, Susan had the $25+$2.50 from week 1 and another $2.50. In other words, Susan had the $25 she started with and two $2.50’s. Time (weeks) Process Amount Saved 0 $25 $25 $25 + $2.50 1 $27.50 2 $30.00 $25 + $2.50 + $2.50 = $25 + 2($2.50) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 132 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions Note that the above step is not a natural step for many students. They are more apt to operate recursively on the previous term , adding $2.50 to $27.50. Teachers need to be aware that this is difficult for some students. Time (weeks) 0 1 2 3 4 Process $25 $25 + $2.50 $25 + $2.50 + $2.50 = $25 + 2($2.50) 25 + 2.5 + 2.5 + 2.5 = 25 + 3(2.50) 25 + 2.5 + 2.5 + 2.5 + 2.5 = 25 + 4(2.50) Amount Saved $25 $27.50 $30.00 $32.50 $35.00 2. Write the sentence in words and then abbreviate to variables: After t weeks, Susan will have the $25 she started with and t ($2.50’s). Because of convention, mathematicians write 2.5t , instead of t (2.5). Time (weeks) Process Amount Saved 25 + t (2.5) = 25 + 2.5t t 25 + 2.5t 3. Use questions to lead participants to find a suitable viewing window. • What does x represent in this problem? [Elapsed time in weeks] • What values make sense for x in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. Zero weeks to 10 weeks.] • What does y represent in this problem? [Total money saved] • What values make sense for y in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. No money to $60.] 4. Sample answer. The variable x stands for elapsed time in weeks so zero to 10 weeks shows a reasonable amount of time. The variable y stands for total money saved, so $0.00 to $60.00 will show all the savings and the xaxis. 5. 25 + 2.5(7) = 42.50 . Susan will have $42.50 after 7 weeks. 6. 25 + 2.5t = 139.99 . After 46 weeks, Susan will have more than $139.99, enough to buy the ring. You may have to open up your window. We did as follows: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 133 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions As an extension, note that the question really asks for an inequality: 25 + 2.5t ≥ 139.99 . 7. Susan’s starting value is lower, so the line will “start” on the y-axis at 15 instead of 25. The y-intercept changed. The slope, or amount of money she saved every week, did not change. The two lines are parallel, with the new line translated down from the original. 8. Susan’s starting value is higher, so the line will “start” on the y-axis at 40 instead of 25. The y-intercept changed. The slope, or amount of money she saved every week, did not change. The two lines are parallel, with the new line translated up from the original. 9. Susan’s rate of saving has changed so the amount of money will not grow as fast, so the line will be less steep. Susan’s rate of saving has changed. Her starting point, or the y-intercept, did not change. The new line is not parallel to the original line because the rate of saving has changed. 10. When the rate of saving changes, the slope of the line changes. 11. When the starting value in Susan’s saving’s plan changed, the starting point, or y-intercept of the line, changed. 12. The point (0, y) is where a line intersects the y-axis. This point represents the starting value of Susan’s savings plan. Activity 2: Spending Money Have participants work through Activity 2 in their groups. Encourage them to practice the language they plan to use when teaching their students. 1. Time (weeks) Process Amount of Money 0 $1090 $1090 $1090 − $30 1 $1060 2 $1030 $1090 − $30 − $30 = $1090 − 2($30) 3 $1000 1090 − 30 − 30 − 30 = 1090 − 3(30) 4 $35.00 1090 − 30 − 30 − 30 − 30 = 1090 − 4(30) 2. Write the sentence in words and then abbreviate to variables: After t weeks, Manuel will have the $1090 he started with minus t ($30’s). Because of convention, mathematicians write 30 , instead of t (30). Time (weeks) Process Amount of Money 1090 − t (30) = 1090 − 30t t 1090 − 30t TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 134 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions 3. Use questions to lead participants to find a suitable viewing window. • What does x represent in this problem? [Elapsed time in weeks] • What values make sense for x in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. Zero weeks to 10 weeks.] • What does y represent in this problem? [Total amount of money] • What values make sense for y in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. $800 to $1090.] 4. Sample answer. The variable x stands for elapsed time in weeks so zero to 10 weeks shows a reasonable amount of time. The variable y stands for total amount of money, so $800 to $1090 will show all his money. 5. 1090 − 30(11) = 760 . Manuel will have $760 after 11 weeks. 6. 1090 − 30t = 0 . After 36 weeks, Manuel will only have $10. He will cannot spend the whole $30 the next week, only $10 and then he will be out of money. You may have to open up your window. An example: 7. Manuel’s starting value is higher, so the line will “start” on the y-axis at 1300 instead of 1090. The y-intercept changed. The slope, or amount of money he spent every week, did not change. The two lines are parallel, with the new line translated up from the original. 8. Manuel’s starting value is lower, so the line will “start” on the y-axis at 890 instead of 1090. The y-intercept changed. The slope, or amount of money he spent every week, did not change. The two lines are parallel, with the new line translated down from the original. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 135 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions 9. Manuel’s rate of spending has changed so now the amount of money will not deplete as fast, so the line will be less steep. Manuel’s rate of saving has changed. His starting point, or the y-intercept, did not change. The new line is not parallel to the original line because the rate of saving has changed. Activity 3: Money, Money, Money Work through Activity 3 with participants. 1. Use questions to find a suitable viewing window. • What does x represent in this problem? [Elapsed time in weeks] • What values make sense for x in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. Zero weeks to 38 weeks.] • What does y represent in this problem? [Total amount of money] • What values make sense for y in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. No money to $1100.] Sample answer. The variable x stands for elapsed time in weeks so zero to 38 weeks shows the time it takes Manuel to spend all of his money. The variable y stands for total amount of money, so $0.00 to $1100 will show both graphs. 2. 25 + 2.5(7) = 42.50 . Susan will have $42.50 after 7 weeks. 3. 25 + 2.5t = 1090 − 30t . They never do have the same amount of money because they are saving or spending each week, not in the middle of the week. This is shown in the table as we choose the increment to be a week not a part of a week. After week 33, Susan has $107.50 and Manuel has $100, which is the closest they get to each other. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 136 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions 4. From earlier work, we found that Manuel had only $10 to spend after 36 weeks. So we will say that after 36 weeks, Manuel is out of money. So the question is now, how much money does Susan have after 36 weeks? Susan has $115 after 36 weeks. To find this answer, we solved 1090 − 30t = 0 and used the solution to solve 25 + 2.5(36) = 115 . Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. a. Yen started with $20. b. Lira started with $0.00. c. Lira is saving $30 a month. d. Mark is saving $10 a month. 2. a. Frank started with $80. b. Ruble started with $40. c. Peso is spending $30 a month. d. Ruble is spending $10 a month. 3. ii, b 4. iii, c 5. iv, a 6. i, d Use the following questions to summarize and connect activities: • What changes in the situation resulted in a change in the steepness of the line? [Changing the rate of spending per week, the amount of money spent per week. Encourage participants to use the word “rate”.] • What changes in the situation resulted in a change in the starting point of the line? [Changing the starting amount of money, initial amount of money.] • Look at your function rules. What does the constant represent in this problem? [The initial, or starting, amount of money] • Look at your function rules. What does the coefficient of x represent in this problem? [Encourage the words “rate of spending”] • Look at your function rules. If the coefficient of x is negative, what does this represent in this problem? [Spending] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 137 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Leaders’ Notes II. Linear Functions • Summary: Look at your function rules. If the coefficient of x is positive, what does this represent in this problem? [Saving] Using real life situations, participants investigate the effects of changing the starting point and the rate of change of a line. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 138 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 1 II. Linear Functions Activity 1: The Birthday Gift Susan’s grandmother gave her $25 for her birthday. Instead of spending the money, she decided to start a savings program by depositing the $25 in the bank. Each week, Susan plans to save an additional $2.50. 1. Make a table of values for the situation. Time (Weeks) Process Amount Saved $25 2. Write a function rule for the amount of money Susan will have after t weeks. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 139 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 1 II. Linear Functions 3. Find a viewing window for the problem situation. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 4. Justify your window choices. Use your graph and table to find the following: 5. How much money will Susan have after 7 weeks? Write this equation. Show how you found your solution. 6. Susan wants to buy a school ring. When will she have enough money to buy the $139.99 ring? Write this equation. Show how you found your solution. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 140 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 1 II. Linear Functions 7. How will the line change if Susan deposits only $15 of the $25? Graph the line. What changed? What did not change? 8. How will the line change if Susan deposits the $25 from her grandmother plus another $15 she already had? Graph the line. What changed? What did not change? 9. How will the line change if Susan deposits the $25 from her grandmother, but decides she can only save $2.00 a week? Graph the line. What changed? What did not change? 10. What changes in the situation resulted in a change in the steepness of the line? 11. What changes in the situation resulted in a change in the starting point of the line? 12. Write the coordinates of the point where a line intersects the y-axis. This point is called the y-intercept. What do these coordinates represent in this problem? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 141 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 2 II. Linear Functions Activity 2: Spending Money Manuel worked all summer and saved $1090. He plans to spend $30 a week. 1. Make a table of values for the situation. Time (Weeks) Process Amount of Money $1090 2. Write a function rule for the amount of money Manuel will have after t weeks. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 142 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 2 II. Linear Functions 3. Find a viewing window for the problem situation. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 4. Justify your window choices. Use your graph and table to find the following: 5. How much money will Manuel have after 11 weeks? Write this equation. Show how you found your solution. 6. When will Manuel be out of money? Write this equation. Show how you found your solution. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 143 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 2 II. Linear Functions 7. How will the line change if Manuel had initially earned $1300? Graph the line. What changed? What did not change? 8. How will the line change if Manuel spent $200 on school clothes and started the year with only $890? Graph the line. What changed? What did not change? 9. How will the line change if Manuel starts with the $1090, but decides he will only spend $25 a week? Graph the line. What changed? What did not change? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 144 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Activity 3 II. Linear Functions Activity 3: Money, Money, Money 1. Manuel has $1090 and he will spend $30 a week. Susan has $25 and will save $2.50 a week. Find a viewing window that includes both situations. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 2. Justify your window choices. Use your graph and table to find the following: 3. When will Manuel and Susan have the same amount of money? Write this equation. Show how you found your solution. 4. How much money will Susan have when Manuel is out of money? Show how you found your solution. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 145 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Reflect and Apply II. Linear Functions Reflect and Apply 1. The graphs represent the savings of three students. Lira 1 2 3 4 1 Months a. b. c. d. Yen Mark 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 Months Months Which student started with the most money? Explain. Which student started with the least money? Explain. Which student is saving the fastest? Explain. Which student is saving the slowest? Explain. 2. The graphs represent the spending habits of three students. Ruble 1 2 Frank 3 4 Months a. b. c. d. 1 2 Months Peso 3 4 1 2 3 4 Months Which student started with the most money? Explain. Which student started with the least money? Explain. Which student is spending the fastest? Explain. Which student is spending the slowest? Explain. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 146 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Reflect and Apply II. Linear Functions Match the recursive routine with an equation and with a graph: 3. _____ 1000 ENTER i. y = 35 − 3 x Ans – 20, ENTER, ENTER, . . . 4. _____ 35 ENTER, Ans + 3, ENTER, ENTER, . . . a b ii. y = 1000 − 20 x 5. _____ 1000 ENTER iii. y = 35 + 3 x Ans + 20, ENTER, ENTER, . . . 6. _____ 35 ENTER, Ans – 3, ENTER, ENTER, . . . iv. y = 1000 + 20 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond c d Spring 2001 147 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Student Activity II. Linear Functions Student Activity: Show Me the Money! Overview: Students connect recursive operations with graphs. Objective: Algebra I TEKS TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 148 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Student Activity II. Linear Functions 6. Time (weeks) Money Saved 0 $1090 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 $1060 $1030 $1000 $970 $940 $910 $880 $ 1,1 2 0 $ 1,0 6 0 M o n $ 1,0 0 0 e y $940 $880 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Time ( weeks) 7. Subtraction, which can also be thought of as repeated addition of a negative number. 8. linear, decreasing. Emphasize that repeated subtraction is the same as repeated addition of a negative number. Assessment Answers: 1. c 2. f 3. d 4. b 5. g 6. e 7. a 8. h Summary: Using a recursive routine, students generate points on a graph and make generalizations. Repeated addition results in a linear graph. Repeated addition of a positive number is an increasing line. Repeated addition of a negative number is an decreasing line. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 149 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Student Activity II. Linear Functions Student Activity: Show Me the Money! Susan’s grandmother gave her $25 for her birthday. Instead of spending the money, she decided to start a savings program by depositing the $25 in the bank. Each week, Susan plans to save an additional $2.50. 1. Write a recursive routine to model Susan’s savings plan. 2. Fill in the table and sketch a graph to model Susan’s savings plan: Time Money (weeks) 3. What operation did you repeat in your recursive routine? 4. How does repeated addition “look” in a graphical representation? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 150 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Student Activity II. Linear Functions Manuel worked all summer and saved $1090. He plans to spend $30 a week. 5. Write a recursive routine to model Manuel’s spending plan. 6. Fill in the table and sketch a graph to model Manuel’s spending plan: Time (weeks) Money 7. What operation did you repeat in your recursive routine? 8. How does repeated subtraction “look” in a graphical representation? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 151 1.2 The Y-Intercept: Student Activity II. Linear Functions Assessment Match the recursive routines with the graphs: 1. ___ 300 ENTER Ans – 20, ENTER, ENTER, . . . 2. ___ 90 ENTER Ans + 20, ENTER, ENTER, . . . a 3. ___ 300 ENTER Ans – 50, ENTER, ENTER, . . . b 4. ___ 300 ENTER Ans + 20, ENTER, ENTER, . . . c 5. ___ 90 ENTER Ans – 20, ENTER, ENTER, . . . 6. ___ 90 ENTER Ans + 50, ENTER, ENTER, . . . d e f g h 7. ___ 300 ENTER Ans + 50, ENTER, ENTER, . . . 8. ___ 90 ENTER Ans - 50, ENTER, ENTER, . . . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 152 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Leaders’ Notes 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change Overview: Participants use real data from a motion detector to model motion at a constant rate over time. Participants translate among algebraic, tabular, graphical, and verbal descriptions of linear functions. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (c.2.A) The student develops the concept of slope as rate of change and determines slopes from graphs, tables, and algebraic representations. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. (c.2.D) The student graphs and writes equations of lines given characteristics such as two points, a point and a slope, or a slope and y-intercept. Terms: rate of change, constant rate Materials: motion detector connected to an overhead calculator, a motion detector with graphing calculator for each group of 3-4, data collection devices, graphing calculators Procedures: The room should be set up with an aisle down the middle. Set up a motion detector pointing down the aisle, connected to an overhead calculator, so the group can see both the participants walking down the aisle and the data projected from the calculator on a screen in front of the room. Work through the Student Activity, Rates of Change, with participants. Talk through the assessment. Make sure each participant gets a chance to write an equation for their own motion over time. Activity 1: Wandering Around Work through Exercise 1 with participants. This activity takes participants from a verbal description of a situation to a graph, table, and rule representing the situation. 1. You know that Ryan was at 9 feet at 3 seconds. Label the table and fill in the (3, 9) as shown. Table Time Distance 3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 9 Spring 2001 153 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Leaders’ Notes Since you know that Ryan was walking at 2 feet per second, count back to find his starting point as shown below. Table Graph Time Distance 0 3 2 1 5 2 2 7 2 3 9 A sentence to describe Ryan’s walk: Start at 3 feet and walk away from the motion detector at 2 feet per second. Rule: y = 3 + 2 x Have participants do Exercise 2 and then discuss their results. 2. You know that Madeline was at 9 feet at 2 seconds. Label the table and fill in (2, 9) as shown. Table Time Distance 2 9 Since you know that Madeline was walking at 3 feet per second, count back to find her starting point as shown below. Table Time Distance 0 15 1 12 2 9 Graph -3 -3 A sentence to describe Ryan’s walk: Start at 15 feet and walk toward the motion detector (decrease the distance) at 3 feet per second. Rule: y = 15 − 3 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 154 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Leaders’ Notes Do Exercises 3 – 4 with participants. 3. You know that Robyn started at 1 foot and she was at 9 feet at 2 seconds. Label the table and fill in (0, 1) and (2, 9) as shown. Table Time Distance 0 1 2 8 2 9 From the table, you can tell that Robyn covered 8 feet in 2 seconds. • If Robyn walked 8 feet in 2 seconds, how far did she walk in one second? [4 feet] • So how fast was she walking per second? [4 feet per second] Table Time Distance 0 1 1 5 2 9 Graph 4 4 A sentence to describe Robyn’s walk: Start at 1 foot and walk away at 4 feet per second. Rule: y = 1 + 4 x 4. You know that Chet was at 6 feet at 1 second and he was at 1 foot at 2 seconds. Label the table and fill in (1, 6) and (2, 1) as shown. Table Time Distance 1 1 2 6 1 -5 From the table, you can tell that Chet covered 5 feet in 1 second, thus his rate was 5 feet per second. 1 1 Time 0 1 2 Table Distance 11 6 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Graph -5 -5 Spring 2001 155 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Leaders’ Notes A sentence to describe Chet’s walk: Start at 11 feet and walk toward the motion detector at 5 feet per second. Rule: y = 11 − 5 x Activity 2: Describe the Walk This activity takes participants from a table representing a situation to a verbal description, graph, and rule of the situation. Have participants work through Exercises 5 – 8 in their groups and then discuss their results. 1. 1 1 Table Time Distance 0 15 1 21 2 27 Graph 6 6 Rule: y = 15 + 6 x Sample verbal description: Start 15 feet in front of the motion detector and walk away at 6 feet per second. 2. Table Graph Time Distance 0 24 1 1 1 23 1 1 2 22 1 1 3 21 1 1 4 20 1 1 5 19 Rule: y = 24 − x Sample verbal description: Start 24 feet in front of the motion detector and walk toward the motion detector (distance decreases) at 1 foot per second. 3. 3 3 Time 0 3 6 Table Distance 1 7 13 Graph 6 6 Rule: y = 1 + 2 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 156 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Leaders’ Notes Sample verbal description: Start 1 foot in front of the motion detector and walk away at 2 feet per second. 4. Table Graph Time Distance 0 -1 3 1 1 2 3 1 2 5 12 4 6 17 12 4 10 29 Rule: y = −1 + 3 x Sample verbal description: Start 1 foot behind the motion detector and walk past it. Continue to walk away at 3 feet per second. (Think outside, or this time, behind the box!) Answers to Reflect and Apply The scatter plot is a finite set of points. It is based on the data collected by the motion detector and is stored in the lists on the calculator. The function rule is an infinite set of points. One way to tell the difference is to trace. When tracing in the scatter plot, the calculator will show each data point from the lists. When tracing on the function rule, the calculator can evaluate the function at any x-value in the domain determined by the window settings (and limited by the calculator’s rounding off.) Often there is confusion when a participant traces on the scatter plot and wants to know why the calculator will not let them trace to a particular value. Summary: By using real data generated from their own motion to determine linear models, participants further develop the concepts of the y-intercept as a starting point and slope as a rate of change. They gain facility in translating among representations: algebraic, tabular, graphical, and verbal descriptions of linear functions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 157 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Activity 1 Activity 1: Wandering Around Label the table and graph. Fill in the table, sketch the graph, and write a symbolic rule for the situation. 1. Ryan was walking away from the motion detector at 2 feet per second. You missed where he started but you know that he was at the 9 foot mark when the timer called out the 3rd second. Table Graph Rule: 2. Madeline was walking toward the motion detector at 3 feet per second. You missed where she started, but you know that she was at the 9 foot mark at the 2nd second. Table Graph Rule: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 158 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Activity 1 3. Robyn started 1 foot from the motion detector. You looked up and she was at 9 feet at the 2nd second. Table Graph Rule: 4. You looked up and Chet was walking! He was at the 6 foot mark at the 1st second and the 1 foot mark at the 2nd second. Table Graph Rule: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 159 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Activity 2 Activity 2: Describe the Walk Label the table and graph. Sketch the graph. Write a symbolic rule and a description of the walk. 1. Table Graph Time Distance 0 15 1 21 2 27 Verbal Description: Rule: 2. Table Time Distance 3 21 4 20 5 19 Graph Verbal Description: Rule: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 160 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Activity 2 3. Table Time Distance 0 1 3 7 6 13 Graph Verbal Description: Rule: 4. Table Time Distance 2 5 6 17 10 29 Graph Verbal Description: Rule: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 161 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply What is the difference between the scatter plot created by the motion detector and the graph of the function rule created by the function grapher? Scatter plot created by the motion detector: Function rule: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 162 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Student Activity: What’s My Trend? Overview: Students investigate the linear model with motion data. Students also use numeric techniques to write the equation of a line. Objective: Algebra I TEKS b.1.B The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. c.2.A The student develops the concept of slope as rate of change and determines slopes from graphs, tables, and algebraic representations. c.2.B The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. Terms: Linear model, rate of change Materials: motion detectors, overhead calculator, data collection devices, graphing calculators Procedures: The classroom should be set up with an aisle down the middle. Set up a motion detector pointing down the aisle, connected to a viewscreen calculator, so the class can see both the students walking down the aisle and the data projected from the calculator on a screen if front of the room. Activity: What’s My Trend? 1. Relate the following situation to your class: Suppose you start 2 feet from a chair and walk away at 1.5 feet per second. Complete the table to show where you are at each second. 0 1 2 10 t • • • 2 3.5 5 ? ? How can you find the distance from the chair at 10 seconds? [Multiply by 1.5 and add 2] Write a sentence to describe how you can find the distance if you know the time. [Distance is 2 plus 1.5 times the time.] Translate the sentence to an equation. [Distance is 2 + 1.5 * time. d = 2 + 1.5t ] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 0 1 2 10 2 3.5 5 17 t 2 + 1.5 t Spring 2001 163 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Make a scatter plot of the data. Show that your equation contains the points by graphing it. 2. Run the motion detector Ranger program. Use the following screens to set up the experiment and then follow the instructions on the screen. Ask a student to walk in front of the motion detector as follows. Start about 2 feet from the motion detector and then walk away from it. When you have a satisfactory graph, press ON, quit, and graph. You should see the graph again. Trace to the points where time is 0 seconds, 1 second, and 2 seconds. Have students fill in the table. x 0 1 2 t TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond y 1.4 2.9 4.4 Spring 2001 164 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Ask: • How can you use the points to find how fast you were going? [Take the difference over 1 second, about 1.5 feet per second.] • Where did you start? [about 1.4 feet] • How can you use your rate and where you started to figure out where you will be in 10 seconds? [1.4 plus 10 times 1.5] • Write a sentence to describe how you can find the distance if you know the time. [Distance is 1.4 plus 1.5 times the time.] • Translate the sentence in words to a sentence in symbols. [Distance = 1.4 + 1.5 * time. d = 1.4 + 1.5t ] Type the equation into the y= menu and graph. Use the table to check your prediction for where you will be in 10 seconds. Now repeat the above procedure for the rest of the walks. Find an equation to fit the data and check your prediction with a table. Examples of different walks follow: Ask a student to start 11 feet away and walk toward the motion detector. (Where were you 2 seconds before?) Ask a student to stand approximately 4 feet from the motion detector and stand still for the whole 4 seconds. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 165 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Assessment: What’s My Trend? 1. b 2. a 3. c 6. y = 1.5 x + 2 7. y = 0.5 + 1x 8. y = 4 + 0.2 x 9. y = 5 − 2 x 10. y = 0.4 x 4. 11. y = 2 + x 12. You rode your bike to the park at a rate of one mile per minute for 3 minutes. Then you talked to your friend at the park for 2 minutes. You both walked back to your house at a rate of 0.6 miles per minute for 5 minutes. 5. Note: This activity was based on the activity Rates of Change in the TEXTEAMS Mathematical Modeling Institute for Secondary Teachers. Summary: Using motion detectors to gather data for their own motion, students develop the concept of slope as a rate of change as students write functions to model the collected data. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 166 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Student Activity: What’s My Trend? 1. Start 2 feet away from the motion detector and walk away at 1.5 ft/sec. t d 0 1 2 10 t 2. Walk slowly away from the motion detector at a constant rate. t d 0 1 2 t 3. Walk quickly away from the motion detector at a constant rate. t d 0 1 2 t 4. Walk slowly toward the motion detector at constant rate. t d 0 1 2 t 5. Walk quickly toward the motion detector at a constant rate. t d 0 1 2 t 6. Stand still about 6 feet in front of the motion detector. t d 0 1 2 t TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 167 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Assessment: What’s My Trend? Match the following equations with the graphs they represent. 1 ___ 1. y = 5 − x 3 ___ 2. y = 1 + 0.5 x ___ 3. y = 2 x + 1 a. b. c. Draw a graph of each of the following: 4. Start 1 foot from the motion detector and stand still for 3 seconds. Then walk away from the motion detector at a rate of 2 feet per second for 2 seconds. Then walk toward it at a rate of 0.2 feet per second for 5 seconds. 5. Start 5 feet from the motion detector and walk toward it at a rate of 2 feet per second for 1 second. Then walk toward the motion detector at a rate of 0.3 feet per second for 3 seconds. Now walk away from the motion detector at a rate of 0.5 feet per second for 6 seconds. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 168 II. Linear Functions 1.3 Exploring Rates of Change: Student Activity Write an equation for each of the following: 6. Start 2 feet from the motion detector and walk away at a rate of 1.5 feet per second. 7. Start 0.5 feet from the motion detector and walk away at a rate of 1 foot per second. Write an equation for each of the following: 8. _______________ 9. _______________ 10. _______________ 11. _______________ 12. Write a story for the following graph using units of hours for time and miles for distance. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 169 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Leaders’ Notes 1.4 Finite Differences Overview: Participants use their cumulative concrete experiences with the linear model to build to the abstract symbolic representations of slope. Finite differences are used to find linear models and to discover what makes data linear. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.2.A) The student develops the concept of slope as rate of change and determines slopes from graphs, tables, and algebraic representations. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. (c.2.D) The student graphs and writes equations of lines given characteristics such as two points, a point and a slope, or a slope and y-intercept. Terms: rate of change, constant rate, constant differences, finite differences Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity 1: Rent Me! Here we introduce rental problems, another good real world linear situation. Have participants work through the activity and share their results. Table Time 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Time 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Cost 12.25 2.25 2.25 = 0.75 3 14.50 Cost 10.00 10.75 11.50 12.25 13.00 13.75 14.50 15.25 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Function rule: y = 10.00 + 0.75 x Spring 2001 170 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Leaders’ Notes Activity 2: Guess My Function! Play Guess My Function using an overhead graphing calculator as shown: Put the Beach Rental equation y = 10 + 0.75 x in the graphing calculator without showing the participants, and using a table, ask for y when x = 2 and x = 4. Give them a minute to figure out the equation. • How can you find the equation? [Take differences and work backwards.] Then enter y = 14 + 1.5 x and give them 3 and 7 for x. Discuss their methods for finding the rate and the starting point. Have participants play Guess My Function with a partner using the tables in Activity 2. Answers: 1. y = 11 + 5 x 2. y = 1.3 + 1.2 x 3. y = 4 − 2 x 4. y = 25 − 7 x 5. y = 16 + 4 x 6. y = −4.9 + 3 x 7. y = 24 − x 8. y = 41 − 5 x 9. y = 11 + 6 x 10. y = 15 − x 11. y = 4 + 2 x 1 12. y = 25 − x 2 13. y = 6 + 2 x 14. y = 8.05 − .25 x 15. y = −2 x 1 16. y = 5 + x 2 Transparency: How Did You Do It? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 171 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Leaders’ Notes Now that participants have many concrete experiences finding rates of change (slopes), we formalize the slope of a line as an algebraic rule. You may use either Transparency 1 or 2. Use Transparency 1 to discuss the process of finding the rate of change both numerically and generally. Use Transparency 2 to develop the ideas live, using Transparency 1 as a guide. • • • What do the values in the table have to do with the points on the graph? [Use the graph to show that the change in y , y2 − y1 , is the vertical distance between the points. Also show that the change in x , x2 − x1 , is the horizontal distance between the points.] ∆y ∆y Where do you find in your rule? [The rate of change is .] ∆x ∆x How can the development of rate of change and slope through concrete experiences enhance student understanding? Extension: In these activities, an algebraic rule for finding the slope between two points on a line was developed. However, up to this point we have always found the y-intercept (starting point) by counting back in the table using the rate of change. Later in the institute, we formalize the point-slope form of a line, but at this point there is another way to find the equation of a line when you have found the slope between the two points. See the example below. Participants are now comfortable with the form of a line, y = b + mx , y = y − intercept + rate( x ) . We use that to our advantage. We will use the information given in Activity 1: Rent Me! Find the rate of change between (3, 12.25) and (6, 14.50) which is $0.75 per hour. Substitute this into the equation of the line, y = b + mx : y = b + 0.75 x . Now choose one of the given points, (3, 12.25) and substitute into the above: 12.25 = b + 0.75(3) and solve for b, b = 10 . So now we have y = 10 + 0.75 x . Activity 3: Finite Differences Work through the Activity with participants. Point out that in all the linear activities up to this point in the institute, we have assumed a constant rate of change. Here we want to emphasize that in order for a function to be linear, the first level of differences must be constant and conversely, if the first differences are constant, the function is linear. ∆x Term Number TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Process Column Spring 2001 Value of Term ∆y 172 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Leaders’ Notes 0 1 2 3 4 1 1 1 1 b+a b+a+a b+a+a+a b+a+a+a+a b b + 1a b + 2a b + 3a b + 4a a a a a b + an n 1. If first differences are constant, then the data is linear. 2. If the data is linear, then first difference are constant. Sample Answers for Reflect and Apply: 1. x 0 1 2 y 11 16 21 Function rule: y = 11 + 5 x Real world scenario: Rent a bicycle built for two at a base charge of $11.00 and $5.00 per hour. Another possible real world scenario: Start with a base of 11 block. Add 5 blocks to each figure. Fig 1: Fig 2: Fig 3: Summary: Building on participants’ previous experiences in the institute with rate of change, we formalize the concept of slope and finite differences. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 173 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Transparency 1 Transparency 1: How Did You Do It? The Slope of a Line With a specific situation: Table Time Distance 2 4 10 − 4 4−2 4 10 Graph (4, 10) (2, 4) } 10-4 4-2 10 − 4 x 4−2 Rule: y = starting point + In general: Table x2 − x1 x x1 x2 y y1 y2 Graph y2 − y1 (x 2, y 2) (x 1, y 1) y 2-y 1 x 2-x 1 Rule: y = starting point + y2 − y1 x , y = starting point + rate( x ) x2 − x1 rate of change = TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond change in y ∆y y −y = = 2 1 change in x ∆x x2 − x1 Spring 2001 174 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Transparency 2 Transparency 2: How Did You Do It? The Slope of a Line With a specific situation: Table Time Distance 2 4 4 10 Graph Rule: In general: Table x Graph y Rule: rate of change = TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 175 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Activity 1 Activity 1: Rent Me! 1. At the beach in Galveston, you decide to rent an umbrella from a beach side vendor. Upon asking for the cost to rent the umbrella for 8 hours, the vendor pulls out a worn and wet table of prices. “Oh, no. What will I do?” exclaimed the vendor! Help the vendor reproduce the price list. What linear function rule can you use? Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Cost $12.25 $14.50 Rule: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 176 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Activity 2 Activity 2: Guess My Function! Write the symbolic rule below each table: 1. x y 2. 0 11 1 16 2 21 x 0 1 2 y 1.3 2.5 3.7 3. x 0 1 2 y 4 2 0 4. x 0 1 2 y 25 18 11 5. x 1 2 3 y 20 24 28 6. x 5 6 7 y 10.1 13.1 16.1 7. x 3 4 5 y 21 20 19 8. x 10 11 12 y -9 -14 -19 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 177 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Activity 2 9. x 0 2 4 y 11 23 35 10. x 0 5 10 y 15 10 5 11. x 0 3 6 y 4 10 16 12. x 0 10 20 y 25 20 15 13. x 2 5 8 y 10 16 22 14. x 11 15 19 y 5.3 4.3 3.3 15. x -7 -5 -3 y 14 10 6 16. x -10 -4 2 y 0 3 6 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 178 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Activity 3 Activity 3: Finite Differences When only one level of differences is necessary to obtain a constant value, the algebraic rule which generates the terms of the sequence is linear and can be written in the form b + an . The terms of a linear sequence are in the form b, b + 1a , b + 2 a , b + 3a , b + 4 a , . . . , an + b . ∆x Term # Process Column 0 _____________ Value of Term ∆y b ___ ___ 1 _____________ b + 1a ___ ___ 2 _____________ b + 2a ___ ___ 3 _____________ b + 3a ___ ___ 4 n _____________ a( n ) + b b + 4a an + b 1. If first differences are constant, then ___________________ 2. If the data is linear, then ____________________________ TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 179 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Refer to the tables in Activity 2. Choose 4 tables from the activity. List them below. Graph each scatter plot and the function rule. Make up a real world scenario for each. Include one real world scenario that can be physically built, such as with centimeter cubes, etc. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 180 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Student Activity Student Activity: Graphs and Tables Overview: Students use graphing calculator programs to find the equations of lines given graphs or tables. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.3.B) Given situations, the student looks for patterns and represents generalizations algebraically. (c.1) The student understands that linear functions can be represented in different ways and translates among their various representations. Terms: rate of change, y-intercept Materials: graphing calculators, LINEGRPH program, LINETBL program Procedures: Link the two programs to students, LINEGRPH and LINETBL. Briefly demonstrate how to run each. An example of each is shown below. The program LINEGRPH: When you run the program, it graphs a randomly generated line in the window [-4.7, 4.7] [-3.1, 3.1]. After examining the graph, enter the equation of the line in Y2 and change the graph style of Y2 to the point tracer. This allows you to see graph more easily. Below is an example of a correct equation because the graphs are the same. If you had entered an incorrect equation, it would graph accordingly and you can quickly see that it is incorrect, as shown below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 181 II. Linear Functions 1.4 Finite Differences: Student Activity The program LINETBL: When you run the program, it displays a randomly generated table of a line. After examining the table, enter the equation of the line in Y2 . Below is an example of a correct equation because the tables return the same values. If you had entered an incorrect equation, it would display a table where the values generated are not the same and you can quickly see that it is incorrect, as shown below. Summary: Using the power of technology to examine many examples quickly and get instant feedback, students gain facility in finding the equations of lines given graphs or tables. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 182 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes 2.1 Out for a Stretch Overview: Participants investigate the relationship between the “stretch” of a rubber band attached to a container and the number of marbles in the container. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (b.1.E) The student interprets and makes inferences from functional relationships. (c.1.A) The student determines whether or not given situations can be represented by linear functions. (c.1.C) The student translates among and uses algebraic, tabular, graphical, or verbal descriptions of linear functions. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. Terms: trend line, linear model, rate of change, slope, y-intercept Materials: for each group of 3 –4 participants: one 8 oz. Styrofoam or paper cup, 3” long thin rubber bands, one 8 oz. cup of marbles of the same size, large paper clips, tape, meter sticks, graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be in groups of 3 – 4. Complete the teacher activity with all of the participants, modeling good pedagogical practices for data collection activities. After completing the teacher activity as a whole group, divide participants into 4 groups, each of which will then do one of the student activities in small groups of 3 – 4. When they have completed their respective student activities, have one small group for each student activity present their activity to the large group. They should include a demonstration of the experiment, a scatter plot of their data, their trend line and discussion of its meaning, and any conclusions. In this way, each participant will actively participate in two linear data collection activities and see three others. If participants have experienced the Hooke’s Law activity in the TEXTEAMS Mathematical Modeling Institute for Secondary Teachers, you may want to choose one of the student activities to do as the whole group activity. Then have any teachers who are not as familiar with the activity do the “Stretch It” teacher activity, while the other teachers complete the remaining student activities. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 183 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes Activity: Stretch It Briefly demonstrate the experiment, clearly showing each of the distances to be measured. 1. Stress the importance of predicting results of the experiment before they perform the experiment. Have participants predict each relationship, one at a time, as you demonstrate the distance to be measured. • What will the values in List 2 represent? [The distance from the table to the top of the cup.] Demonstrate this measurement and have participants sketch their prediction of the graph of (list 1, list 2). • What will the values in List 3 represent? [The distance from the table to the bottom of the cup.] Demonstrate this measurement and have participants sketch their prediction of the graph of (list 1, list 3). • What will the values in List 4 represent? [The distance from the bottom of the cup to the floor.] Demonstrate this measurement and have participants sketch their prediction of the graph of (list 1, list 4). 2. Have participants create their “hanging containers” as shown and collect the data. Have participants fill in the table accordingly. Make sure participants measure the distances from the free hanging cup, before any marbles are added. • Which measure is the dependent variable and which is the independent variable? Justify your response. [The number of marbles is the independent variable because we are controlling this number. The distances from the table are dependent because they rely, depend, on how many marbles are in the cup.] Sample data: Number of marbles List 1 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 Distance from table to top of cup (cm) List 2 16 16.5 16.9 17.2 17.5 17.8 18.2 Distance from table to bottom of cup (cm) List 3 26.1 26.4 27 27.3 27.6 27.8 28.2 Distance from bottom of cup to floor (cm) List 4 51.6 51.2 50.8 50.5 50.2 49.8 49.4 Have the recorder enter the data in a graphing calculator and link with the other members of the group. Have one group write their data on the transparency of Activity 1 to use with the whole group. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 184 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes First find a trend line for List 2 (distance from the table to the top of the cup) versus List 1 (number of marbles) together as a group. • Is the graph linear or non-linear? [Answers will vary. It looks linear.] • How can you decide if the data is linear? [Based on the work in 2.1.4 Finite Differences, if the first differences are relatively constant, it makes sense to model the data with a linear model.] 4. Have participants use mental math to find first differences on the data in List 2 as you find first differences on the transparency of Activity 1. Number of marbles List 1 0 5 5 5 10 5 15 5 20 5 25 5 30 Distance from table to top of cup (cm) List 2 16 0.5 16.5 0.4 16.9 0.3 17.2 0.3 17.5 0.3 17.8 0.4 18.2 Distance from table to bottom of cup (cm) List 3 26.1 0.3 26.4 0.6 27 0.3 27.3 0.3 27.6 0.2 27.8 0.4 28.2 Distance from bottom of cup to floor (cm) List 4 51.6 0.4 51.2 0.4 50.8 0.3 50.5 0.3 50.2 0.4 49.8 0.4 49.4 change in y . Take an average change in x of the differences in List 2 and divide by 5 (the constant difference in List 1.) .37 For the sample data above, rate of change ≈ = 0.074 cm/marble. 5 To estimate a rate of change per marble, find 5. We do not need to estimate because we found the distance for no marbles in the cup. For our sample data, the y-intercept is 16 cm. 6. For our sample data, y = 16 + 0.074 x 7. 8. The units of slope are centimeters per marble. 9. The y-intercept represents the distance from the table to the top of the cup when the cup is empty. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 185 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes change in y . Take an average of the change in x differences in List 3 divided by 5 (the constant difference in List 1.) For .35 the sample data above, rate of change ≈ = 0.07 cm/marble. 5 12. We do not need to estimate because we found the distance for no marbles in the cup. For our sample data, the y-intercept is 26.1 cm. 13. For our sample data, y = 26.1 + 0.07 x 11. To estimate a rate of change, find 14. 15. The units of slope are centimeters per marble. 16. The y-intercept represents the distance from the table to the bottom of the cup when the cup is empty. change in y . Take an average of the change in x differences in List 4 divided by 5 (the constant difference in List 1.) For .37 the sample data above, rate of change ≈ = 0.074 cm/marble. 5 19. We do not need to estimate because we found the distance for no marbles in the cup. For our sample data, the y-intercept is 51.6 cm. 20. For our sample data, y = 51.6 + 0.074 x 18. To estimate a rate of change, find 21. 22. The units of slope are centimeters per marble. 23. The distance from the floor to the bottom of the cup when the cup is empty. Activity 2: Comparing Graphs 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 186 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes 2. For the sample data: #1: y = 16 + 0.074 x #2: y = 26.1 + 0.07 x #3: y = 51.6 − 0.074 x 3. The slope for trend line #3 is negative because the distance from the floor to the bottom of the cup is decreasing. The slopes of trend lines #1 and #2 are positive because the distances from the table to the top or bottom of the cup are increasing. The magnitudes of the slopes of the three trend lines are very close to one another. This is because the slopes all represent the number of centimeters the cup moved for each marble added. 4. For the sample data the difference between the y-intercept of trend line #1 and the y-intercept of trend line #2 is 26.1 − 16 = 10.1cm. This distance is the length of the cup. 5. Sample data. One way to find when the cup will touch the floor is to find when the distance from the bottom of the cup to the floor is zero. This relationship is represented by trend line #3, y = 51.6 − 0.074 x . Therefore, find x when 0 = 51.6 − 0.074 x . Another way to find when the cup will touch the floor is to find when the distance from the table to the bottom of the cup is equal to the height of the table. So, the height of the table is the distance from the floor to the table equals the distance from the table to the bottom of the cup and the distance from the floor to the bottom of the cup which is: 26.1 + 51.6 = 77.7 cm . So the question is when does trend line #2 equal 77.7? Therefore, find x when 26.1 + 0.07 x = 77.7 . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 187 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes (The above two methods produce different solutions because they use different trend lines that used slightly different rates of change.) 6. Sample data: 16 + 0.074( 42) = 19.108 Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. Either Group 1’s marbles are much heavier than Group 2’s marbles or Group 1’s rubberband is stretchier than Group 2’s. 2. Group 1’s table is taller than Group 2’s. Group 1’s cup is taller than Groups 2’s by 0.5 cm. 3. The intersection point is when the distance from the table to the top of the cup equals the distance from the floor to the bottom of the cup. It is the number of marbles that move the cup to a point halfway between the table and the floor. Math Note: Hooke’s Law: The force exerted by a spring is proportional to the distance the spring is stretched or compressed from it’s relaxed position, that is that the tension exerted by a stretched string is (within certain limits) proportional to the extension, or, in other words, that the stress is proportional to the strain. Robert Hooke, 1635- 1703, had many varied interests from physics and astronomy, to chemistry, biology, and geology. He made many important scientific contributions. Note that Hooke’s law is based on a spring. In this activity, we use a rubber band instead of a spring to achieve similar results. If desired, use a spring for the most accurate results. Another alternative is to use a slinky to simulate a spring. Note: This activity was based on the activity “Linear Modeling in Science” in the TEXTEAMS Mathematical Modeling Institute for Secondary Teachers. Note on Student Activity Sample Assessments: The sample items are intended to provide teachers with possible ways to assess the data collection activities. They are not intended to show the best or only assessments possible. Have participants suggest other possible techniques. Have participants compare the Sample Assessments and discuss the different objectives of each. For example, one Sample Assessment prompts students for a graphical solution, another for a tabular solution, and another for two solutions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 188 II. Linear Functions Summary: 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Leaders’ Notes Participants collect and analyze data to find the relationships between the number of marbles in the cup and selected distances from the cup. By concluding that a linear model is a reasonable model, participants demonstrate that a spring stretches at a constant rate, Hooke’s Law. By using differences and estimating rates of change with real data, participants further cement the concept of the linear model. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 189 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Activity 1 Activity 1: Stretch It What is the relationship between the number of marbles in the cup and the distances shown below? Use large paper clips and an 8 oz. paper cup to form a “hanging container.” Measure the distances indicated below as marbles are added to the cup. Table Rubberband List 2 List 3 Paper clips List 4 Floor 1. Predict a graph of the relationship between the number of marbles in the cup and the distances shown above. You should predict 3 different graphs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 190 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Activity 1 2. Measure the indicated distances and record in the table below. Next, add 5 marbles to the container and measure each distance as before. Record the new measurements. Continue this process: add 5 marbles to the container, measure, and record. Number Distance from Distance from Distance from of table to top of table to bottom bottom of cup marbles cup (cm) of cup (cm) to floor (cm) List 1 List 2 List 3 List 4 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 Trend line #1: Consider the relationship between the distance from the table to the top of the cup (List 2) and the number of marbles (List 1.) 3. 4. Create a scatter plot using a graphing calculator. Estimate a rate of change by finding first differences in your data. 5. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 6. Use the estimated rate and y-intercept to find a trend line for your data. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 191 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Activity 1 7. Graph the trend line over the scatter plot. Adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 8. What are the units of slope for the trend line? 9. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? Trend line #2: Consider the relationship between the distance from the table to the bottom of the cup (List 3) and the number of marbles (List 1.) 10. Create a scatter plot using a graphing calculator. 11. Estimate a rate of change by finding first differences in the data. 12. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 13. Use the estimated rate and y-intercept to find a trend line for your data. 14. Graph the trend line over the scatter plot. Adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 15. What are the units of slope for the trend line? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 192 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Activity 1 16. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? Trend line #3: Consider the relationship between the distance from the floor to the bottom of the cup (List 4) and the number of marbles (List 1.) 17. Create a scatter plot using graphing calculator. 18. Estimate a rate of change by finding first differences in the data. 19. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 20. Use the estimated rate and y-intercept to find a trend line for your data. 21. Graph the trend line over the scatter plot. Adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 22. What are the units of slope for the trend line? 23. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 193 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Activity 2 Activity 2: Comparing Graphs 1. Graph all three scatter plots and trend lines on your calculator in the same window. Sketch: 2. Write the equations of the trend lines. Trend line #1, List 2 vs List 1: Trend line #2, List 3 vs List 1: Trend line #3, List 4 vs List 1: 3. Compare the slopes of the trend lines. What do you find? 4. Find the difference between the y-intercept of trend line #1 and the y-intercept of trend line #2. Where is this distance in the experiment? 5. Use your trend line to determine when the cup will touch the floor. Describe your strategy. 6. Use your trend lines to determine how far the top of the cup would be from the table if you added 42 marbles. Describe your strategy. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 194 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Group 1 Group 2 1. What can you conclude about Group 1’s marbles and rubber band compared to that of Group 2? 2. What can you conclude about Group 1’s table and cup compared to that of Group 2? 3. What is the meaning of the intersection point shown below from Group 1? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 195 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 Student Activity 1: Have You Lost Your Marbles? Overview: Students investigate the relationship between the height of an object and the distance the object rolls. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (b.1.E) The student interprets and makes inferences from functional relationships. (c.1.A) The student determines whether or not given situations can be represented by linear functions. (c.1.C) The student translates among and uses algebraic, tabular, graphical, or verbal descriptions of linear functions. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. (b.2.D) In solving problems, the student collects and organizes data, makes and interprets scatter plots and models, predicts, and makes decisions and critical judgments. Terms: rate, slope Materials: each group needs 5 – 6 building blocks, 39 cm of PVC pipe, marble or steel ball bearing that will fit inside and roll freely through the PVC pipe, metric tape measure, graphing calculators Procedures: Students should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity: Have You Lost Your Marbles? Briefly describe and/or demonstrate the experiment. Make sure students measure the distance the marble rolls once it leaves the end of the pipe. 1. Stress how important it is for students to predict the results of the experiment before they perform the experiment. Encourage students to think about and anticipate the results of the experiment before they begin collecting data. 2. Sample data: Height Distance (blocks) (cm) 1 19 2 53.5 3 74 4 100 5 137.5 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 196 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 3. Sample data: 4. Sample data: An estimate for the rate of change is about 30 cm/block. 5. Since the rate of change is about 30, then the y-intercept is about 19 − 30 = −11 . 6. Using our sample data, y = −11 + 30 x 7. Sample data: 8. The units of slope are centimeters per block. 9. The real world meaning of the y-intercept is that for zero blocks the marble does not roll out of the pipe at all, it covers no distance. 10. The equation is y = −13 + 30(20) . Some solution methods: 11. For our sample data, solve: −13 + 30 x = 60 . Some solution methods: Table: Other Table: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 197 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 Trace: Trace to the Intersection point. Guess and check. Solve algebraically, if you are at a place in your curriculum where it makes sense for students to do so: −13 + 30 x = 60 −13 + 30 x + 13 = 60 + 13 1 30 x = 73 1 30 30 x = 2.43 12. The more blocks placed under the pipe, the farther the marble travels. • • • Did the height of the pipe increase the distance the marble rolled? [Yes.] Why or why not? [The marble has more potential (stored) energy with greater height.] If the slope keeps increasing, will the marble roll farther each time? Why or why not? [Up to a point, yes. When the slope is completely vertical, the marble will not roll far because its energy is absorbed by the ground.] Extensions. Find the trend lines for the following and compare. • Use different sized marbles (as long as they still travel freely through the pipe), • Use spheres with different masses (i.e., golf balls, ping pong balls, steel ball bearings), • Use different surfaces (i.e., rug, cement, dirt, table top, sheets). Answers to Sample Assessment TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 198 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 1. 2. With 7 blocks, the marble will roll approximately 163 cm. Some solution methods are shown below. Trace to x = 7 Solve using the trend line and arithmetic. Use a table. 3. x ≈ 10 . Students’ answers should be close, depending on their trend lines. Some solution methods are shown below: Trace to the intersection of y = 2 + 23 x and y = 232 Use a table, in two ways Trace to y = 232 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 199 II. Linear Functions Summary: 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 By collecting data and finding a trend line, students investigate the relationship between the height of an object and the distance it rolls. Students use real data to further their conceptualization of the linear function. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 200 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 Student Activity 1: Have You Lost Your Marbles? What is the relationship between the height of the pipe and the distance the marble rolls? Measure Roll the marble from heights of 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 blocks. Release the marble at the opening of the pipe. Measure the distance the marble rolls from the end of the pipe. 1. Sketch a graph predicting the relationship between the height of the pipe and the distance the marble rolls. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 201 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 2. Data Collection Tasks: • one person rolls the marble, • one person holds the blocks and pipe, • one person marks where the marble stops, • one person measures the distance the marble traveled. Height (blocks) Distance (cm) 3. Make a scatter plot using a graphing calculator. Sketch below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 202 II. Linear Functions 4. 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 Use first differences to estimate a rate of change. 5. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 6. Find a trend line for the data using the estimated rate and yintercept. 7. Graph your trend line over the scatter plot. Adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 8. What are the units of slope for the trend line? 9. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? 10. Use your trend line to determine how far the marble would roll if you placed 20 blocks under the pipe. Write an equation and solve in at least four ways. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 203 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 11. Use your trend line to determine how many blocks are needed for the marble to roll 60 cm. Write an equation and solve in at least four ways. 12. Make a general statement about the relationship between the number of blocks and the distance the marble travels. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 204 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 1 Sample Assessment A group collected the following data for “Have You Lost Your Marbles?” Height Distance (blocks) (cm) 1 25 2 47.5 3 73.75 4 92 5 117 1. Create a scatter plot and find a trend line. Sketch both in an appropriate window. 2. Use the graph to determine how far the marble would roll with 7 blocks. Solve in two ways. Show your work. 3. Use the graph to determine how many blocks it would take for the marble to roll 232 cm. Solve in two ways. Show your work. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 205 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 Student Activity 2: Unidentified Circular Objects (UCO’s) Overview: Students investigate the relationship between the diameter of a circular light on a surface produced by a flashlight and the distance of the flashlight from the surface. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (b.1.E) The student interprets and makes inferences from functional relationships. (c.1.A) The student determines whether or not given situations can be represented by linear functions. (c.1.C) The student translates among and uses algebraic, tabular, graphical, or verbal descriptions of linear functions. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. Terms: diameter, trend line, linear model, rate of change, slope, y-intercept Materials: flashlights (one per group), rulers, yardstick or meter stick, graphing calculators Procedures: Students should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity 1: Unidentified Circular Objects Briefly describe and/or demonstrate the experiment. Make sure students hold the meter stick perpendicular to the surface on which the light is shining. 1. Stress how important it is for students to predict the results of the experiment before they perform the experiment. Encourage students to think about and anticipate the results of the experiment before they begin collecting data. 2. Sample data: Distance (cm) 1 2 3 4 5 6 9 10 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Diameter 6.5 8.5 10.6 12.4 14.5 16.3 22.3 24.6 Spring 2001 206 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 3. Sample data: 4. Rate of change is approximately 2 cm/cm 5. Estimated starting point is 4.5 cm. 6. y = 4.5 + 2 x 7. Sample data: 8. The units of slope are centimeters per centimeters. 9. The real world meaning of the y-intercept is that if the flashlight was no centimeters from the surface, the circular light pattern would have the yintercept as its diameter. 10. The equation is y = 4.5 + 2(15) = 34.5 . Some solution methods: 11. For our sample data, solve: 4.5 + 2 x = 18 Table: Other Table: Trace: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 207 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 Trace to the Intersection point. Guess and check. Solve algebraically, if you are at a place in your curriculum where it makes sense for students to do so: 4.5 + 2 x = 18 4.5 + 2 x − 4.5 = 18 − 4.5 1 2 x = 13.5 1 2 2 x = 6.75 12. The further from the surface the flashlight is, the larger the circular light pattern produced. Answers to Sample Assessment: 1. 2. Trace to x = 3.5 3. Two graphical methods: Trace to y = 20 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 208 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 Trace to the intersection of y = 3.6 + 1.5 x and y = 20 Summary: By collecting data and finding a trend line, students investigate the relationship between the diameter of the circular light pattern produced by a flashlight at varying distances from the surface. Students use real data to further their conceptualization of the linear function. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 209 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 Activity 2: UCO’s What is the relationship between the diameter of the circular light pattern cast by a flashlight and the flashlight’s distance from the circular light pattern? Diameter Distance Vary the distance of the flashlight from the surface and measure the diameter of the circular light pattern cast by the flashlight. 1. Sketch a graph predicting the relationship between the diameter of the circular light pattern cast by a flashlight and the flashlight’s distance from the circular light pattern. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 210 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 2. Data Collection Hold a yardstick perpendicular to a flat surface, such as a table, with the end starting at 0 on the flat surface. Hold a flashlight next to the meter stick so that it will cast light on the flat surface. Place the rim of the flashlight (light source end) at 1 cm and measure the diameter of the distinct circular pattern formed on the flat surface. Record in the table below. Continue to vary the distance of the flashlight from the table and record the diameter of the circle formed. Distance (cm) Diameter 1 2 3 4 5 6 9 10 3. Make a scatter plot using a graphing calculator. Sketch below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 211 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 4. Use first differences to estimate a rate of change. 5. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 6. Find a trend line for the data using the estimated rate and yintercept. 7. Graph your trend line over the scatter plot and adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 8. What are the units of slope for the trend line? 9. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? 10. Use the trend line to determine the diameter of the circle when the flashlight is 15 cm from the flat surface. Write the equation and solve in at least three ways. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 212 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 11. Use the trend line to determine how far the rim of the flashlight is from the flat surface if the diameter of the circle is 18 cm. Write the equation and solve in at least four ways. 12. Make a general statement about the relationship between the distance of the flashlight from the surfaces and the diameter of the circular light pattern produced on the surface. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 213 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 2 Sample Assessment A group collected the following data for Unidentified Circular Objects. Distance (cm) 1 2 3 4 5 Diameter (cm) 5 6.4 8 9.6 11 1. Create a scatter plot and find a trend line. Sketch both in an appropriate window. 2. Use the graph to determine what the diameter of the circular light pattern is when the flashlight is 3.5 cm from the surface. Show on the graph how you found the answer. 3. Use the graph to determine how far the flashlight is from the surface when the diameter of the circular light pattern is 20 cm. Show on the graph how you found the answer. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 214 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 Student Activity 3: Going to Great Depths Overview: Students investigate the relationship between the height of water in a cylinder and the number of bolts that have been added to the cylinder. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (b.1.E) The student interprets and makes inferences from functional relationships. (c.1.A) The student determines whether or not given situations can be represented by linear functions. (c.1.C) The student translates among and uses algebraic, tabular, graphical, or verbal descriptions of linear functions. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. (b.2.D) In solving problems, the student collects and organizes data, makes and interprets scatter plots and models, predicts, and makes decisions and critical judgments. Terms: rate, slope Materials: each group needs a cylinder (obtain from a science class, use a pharmacy medication bottle that is cylindrical, or use a cylindrical flat-bottomed drinking glass), uniform objects that will fit in the cylinder and sink (golf balls, marbles, centimeter cubes), water, metric ruler, graphing calculators Procedures: Students should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Note: for the sample data below, we used a cylinder and 4 golf balls. You can also use marbles but instead of adding one at a time, add 5 marbles at a time. You want the displacement to be enough to be able to measure easily. If you use 5 marbles each time, adjust the questions accordingly. Activity: Going to Great Depths Briefly describe and/or demonstrate the experiment. Make sure students measure the water level before adding any objects. 1. Stress how important it is for students to predict the results of the experiment before they perform the experiment. Encourage students to think about and anticipate the results of the experiment before they begin collecting data. 2. Sample data: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 215 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 Number of Objects 0 1 2 3 4 Height (cm) 9 10.2 11.5 12.7 13.9 3. Sample data: 4. For our sample data, an estimated rate of change is 1.2 centimeters per object. 5. For our sample data, the y-intercept is the original water level, 9 cm. 6. For our sample data, a trend line is y = 9 + 1.2 x . 7. 8. The units of slope are centimeters per object. 9. The real-world meaning of the y-intercept is that for zero objects the water level is the original level before there were any objects added. 10. The equation is y = 9 + 1.2(9) . Some solution methods: 11. For our sample data, the highest water level recorded was 13.9 centimeters so we need to find how many objects would cause the water to rise to 13.9 + 6 = 19.9 cm. Solve: 9 + 1.2 x = 19.9 . Some solution methods: Table: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 216 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 Trace: Trace to the Intersection point. Guess and check. Solve algebraically, if you are at a place in your curriculum where it makes sense for students to do so: 9 + 1.2 x = 19.9 9 + 1.2 x − 9 = 19.9 − 9 1 1.2 x = 10.9 1 1.2 1.2 x = 9.083 12. The more objects placed in the cylinder, the higher the level of the water. 13. The rate of change would be higher because larger objects would displace more water. Therefore the line would be steeper, have a higher slope. 14. If you added the same amount of water, the original water level would be higher. Therefore the line would shift up. Also, while the objects would still displace the same amount of water, this amount of water displaced in a smaller container would make the rate of change increase. Therefore the slope of the line would be steeper. Answers to Sample Assessment 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 217 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 2. Using a table. 3. x ≈ 31. Students answers should be close, depending on their trend lines. Using a table, in 2 ways Summary: By collecting data and finding a trend line, students investigate the relationship between the height of water in a cylinder and the number of uniform objects added to the cylinder. Students use real data to further their conceptualization of the linear function. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 218 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 Student Activity 3: Going to Great Depths What is the relationship between the number of uniform objects added to the cylinder and the height of the water in the cylinder? Add uniform objects to the cylinder. Measure the height of the water with each additional object. 1. Sketch a graph predicting the relationship between the height of the water and the number of objects added: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 219 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 2. Data Collection Number of Objects Height (cm) 3. Make a scatter plot using a graphing calculator. Sketch below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 220 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 4. Use first differences to estimate a rate of change. 5. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 6. Find a trend line for the data using the estimated rate and yintercept. 7. Graph your trend line over the scatter plot and adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 8. What are the units of slope for the trend line? 9. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? 10. Use your trend line to determine how high the water would rise with 9 objects in the cylinder. Write the equation and solve in at least three ways. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 221 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 11. Use your trend line to determine how many objects are needed to make the water rise 6 cm higher than the highest water level recorded (assuming the container could hold that much water.) Write the equation and solve in at least four ways. 12. Make a general statement about the relationship between the number of uniform objects and the height of the water. 13. Suppose you used larger objects. Predict how the graph would change. 14. Suppose you used a cylinder whose diameter is half that of the original cylinder. Predict how the graph would change. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 222 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 3 Sample Assessment A group collected the following data for Going to Great Depths. Number of Objects 0 1 2 3 4 Height (cm) 15 16.1 17 18.2 19 1. Create a scatter plot and find a trend line. Sketch both in an appropriate window. 2. Use a table on a graphing calculator to determine how high the water level would be with 10 added objects. Show how you found your answer. 3. Use the table on a graphing calculator to determine how many objects were added if the water level is 45 cm, (assuming the container is tall enough.) Show how you found your answer. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 223 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 Student Activity 4: Height versus Arm Span Overview: Students investigate the relationship between the height of person and the person’s arm span. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (b.1.E) The student interprets and makes inferences from functional relationships. (c.1.A) The student determines whether or not given situations can be represented by linear functions. (c.1.C) The student translates among and uses algebraic, tabular, graphical, or verbal descriptions of linear functions. (c.2.B) The student interprets the meaning of slope and intercepts in situations using data, symbolic representations, or graphs. (b.2.D) In solving problems, the student collects and organizes data, makes and interprets scatter plots and models, predicts, and makes decisions and critical judgments. (c.2.G) The student relates direct variation to linear functions and solve problems involving proportional change. Terms: rate, slope, arm span, proportional relationship Materials: metric measuring tape or meter stick(s), graphing calculators Procedures: Students should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity: Height versus Arm Span Briefly describe and/or demonstrate the experiment. 1. Stress how important it is for students to predict the results of the experiment before they perform the experiment. Encourage students to think about and anticipate the results of the experiment before they begin collecting data. 2. Sample data: Arm Span (cm) 171.5 169 169 170 159 179 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Height (cm) 170 166.5 169 175 166 184 Spring 2001 224 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 3. Sample data: 4. For our sample data, an estimated rate of change is 1 centimeters per 1 centimeter. 5. For our sample data, we could reason that the y-intercept is the theoretical height of a person with no arm span, therefore the y-intercept is zero. 6. For our sample data, a trend line is y = 0 + 1x . 7. 8. The units of slope are centimeters of height per centimeters of arm span. Since the units (centimeters) are the same, cm = 1 and therefore, the slope is this case is dimensionless. To illustrate, cm consider if the measurements would have been made in inches, feet, cubits, or pencil lengths. The units of slope would be the same, unit of measure = 1. unit of measure 9. The real world meaning of the y-intercept is that for a theoretical person with no arm span, the person would have no height. 10. y = 1(137) = 137 . Students could solve using a table, tracing on the graph, and evaluating on the home screen. See the other student activities for examples of solution methods. 11. 1x = 214 . Students could solve using a table where y = x , using a table where y = x and y = 214 , tracing on the graph, finding the intersection of y = x and y = 214 , and using guess and check on the home screen. See the other student activities for examples of solution methods. 12. The longer your arm span is, the taller you are. 13. Neither variable is the independent or dependent variable. There is not a dependent relationship inherent in this situation. The two relationships (arm span, height) and (height, arm span) are inverse relations. 14. The ratios should be somewhat constant and approximately equal to 1. y 15. The average of the ratio should be very close to the slope of the trend x line, approximately 1. y 16. If = k , then k is the constant of proportionality. x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 225 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 Answers to Sample Assessment: 1 – 2. The points in the scatter plot for Group A all lie below the line y = x . This means the people measured by Group A have longer arm spans than their heights. However, the points in the scatter plot for Group B all lie above the line y = x . This means the people measured by Group B are taller than their arm spans. Also, noting the different windows, the points in the scatter plot for Group A must have generally higher coordinates than those for Group B. The folks measured by A are taller than those measured by Group B. 3. The points should have relatively high coordinates and lie below the line y = x. Summary: By collecting data and finding a trend line, students investigate the relationship between the height of a person and the person’s arm span. Students use real data to further their conceptualization of the linear function, specifically of the form y = mx , a proportional relation. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 226 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 Student Activity 4: Height versus Arm Span What is the relationship between the height of a person and the length of the person’s arm span? Measure the height and arm span of students. 1. Sketch a graph predicting the relationship between the height of the person and the person’s arm span: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 227 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 2. Data Collection Arm Span (cm) Height (cm) 3. Make a scatter plot using a graphing calculator. Sketch below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 228 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 4. Use first differences to estimate a rate of change. 5. Estimate the y-intercept (starting point.) 6. Find a trend line for the data using the estimated rate and yintercept. 7. Graph your trend line over the scatter plot and adjust the parameters y-intercept and rate of change, if necessary, for a better fit. 8. What are the units of slope for the trend line? 9. What is the meaning of the y-intercept in the trend line? 10. Use the trend line to determine how tall a person is with an arm span of 137 cm. Write an equation and solve in at least three ways. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 229 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 11 . Use your trend line to determine what arm span a 214 cm tall person would have? Write an equation and solve in at least four ways. 12. Make a general statement about the relationship between the height of a person and the person’s arm span. 13. Which is the independent variable and which is the dependent variable in this problem situation? A linear relationship that contains the origin is called a proportional relationship and is in the form y = mx . 14. In the table, find the average of the ratios, y . x y above to the slope in your x trend line. What do you find? 15. Compare the average ratio 16. If y = k , what is k called? x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 230 II. Linear Functions 2.1 Out for a Stretch: Student Activity 4 Sample Assessment Two groups collected data for height versus arm span. Their scatter plots in relation to the line y = x are shown below. Group A Group B 1. Name one difference between the people measured by Group A and the people measured by Group B. 2. Name another difference between the people measured by Group A and the people measured by Group B. 3. What would a graph look like of mostly tall people whose arm spans tended to be greater than their heights? Sketch the graph and include the line y = x . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 231 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes 2.2 Linear Regression Overview: Participants write a program to find a least squares linear function to model data. They use the program and calculator regression to find linear models for data and they discuss the correlation coefficient, r. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.2.C) The student investigates, describes, and predicts the effects of changes in m and b on the graph of y = mx + b . Terms: trend line, line of best fit, linear regression, residual, r, correlation coefficient Materials: graphing calculator, dynamic geometry program with a prepared demonstration of a linear least squares fit for data, computer with a projection device. Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Math Note: With the advent of graphing calculators, many have begun to use calculator regression to find models for data. This activity is designed to help participants understand how a linear regression model is calculated, to discuss when and how to use calculator linear regression, to think about the pedagogical issues associated with calculator linear regression, and to correctly understand how to use (or not to use) the correlation coefficient, r. The least squares method of finding a line of best fit is accessible for teachers, especially if looked at geometrically, using a dynamic geometry program and also if looked at numerically, using a graphing calculator. Begin by showing a geometric demonstration of the least squares method for finding a line of best fit and discuss as follows. Help orient participants by pointing out the data set (points) and the trend line. Make sure the trend line is not close to the line of best fit so that the “squares” can be seen. When finding a line of best fit, we desire to minimize the distance between the y-values of the data and the function values of the line. (A statistician might say that we want to minimize the difference between an observed value of the response variable and the value predicted by the regression line.) The closer the line is to the data, the smaller the differences will be. Because the differences may be positive (if the data point is above the line) or negative (the data point is below the line), we then look at the squares of the differences. Hence we are really looking to minimize the squares of the differences. This can be shown on the dynamic geometry program as shown below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 232 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes The following graphs come from a demonstration sketch from the Geometer’s Sketchpad. The original sketch: 2 P6 P5 P4 P2 yint -2 P3 P1 Slope 2 4 Points P1 through P6 represent data points. A line is drawn through the points and from each data point to the line a square is constructed. Drag the y-intercept and slope of the line so that the sum of the areas of the squares is minimized. That line is the least squares regression line for the data. Bill Finzer, 3/95 Total Area = 0.82 inches 2 -2 Show participants the data set and the trend line. Point out the differences between the data and the trend line, and the visuals representing the square of the differences (shaded squares) as shown below. Use the Transparency to illustrate. This square represents 2 ( y1 − f ( x1 )) for point P 1 (x1, y1 ) 2 P6 } P2 } y int } P3 P1 Slope -2 2 -2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond } P5 P4 Spring 2001 4 The differences between the y-values of the points and the function values of the line. 233 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Use the dynamic geometry program to raise the y-intercept of the trend line and watch the differences get larger, and hence, the squares get bigger. Note the total area gets bigger as the squares get bigger. 2 P6 P5 P4 P2 y int P3 P1 Slope -2 2 4 Total Area = 2.34 inches 2 -2 Use the dynamic geometry program to lower the y-intercept of the trend line and watch the differences get smaller, and hence, the squares get smaller. Note the total area gets smaller as the squares get smaller. 2 P6 P5 P4 P2 P3 P1 y int -2 2 4 Slope Total Area = 0.56 inches 2 -2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 234 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Use the dynamic geometry program to change the slope of the trend line to make it steeper and watch the squares change. Note the total area. 2 P6 P5 P4 P2 y int -2 P3 P1 Slope 2 4 Total Area = 2.72 inches 2 -2 Use the dynamic geometry program to change the slope of the trend line to make it less steep and watch the squares change. Note the total area. 2 P6 P5 P4 P2 Slope y int P3 P1 -2 2 4 Total Area = 1.56 inches 2 -2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 235 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Change both the y-intercept and the slope to minimize the total area. When the area is as small as you can get it, you have a line of best fit using a least squares method. If you desire, you can display the equation of your line of best fit as shown. 2 y = 0.39x + 0.33 P6 P5 P4 P2 P3 y int P1 Slope -2 2 4 Total Area = 0.16 inches 2 -2 • • Using the method of least squares, why do we square the differences and then sum them? Why do we not just sum the differences? [Some of the differences might be positive, while others might be negative. Adding these together, they may cancel each other out. You would get a small sum but you might not have a very good fit. Also the points that are furthest from the line adds much more weight than points close to the line, when their differences are squared.] How has this geometrical approach added to your understanding of linear regression? Math Note: The difference between the y-value of the data point and the function value of the trend line is called the residual. Therefore, we want to minimize the sum of the squares of each of the residuals to achieve a better fit. A method of discussing the appropriateness of a model is to look at a residual plot, (x-value, residual). This leads more into statistics and modeling and will not be discussed more in the institute. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 236 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Activity 1: Sums of Squares Now participants use a numeric approach to finding a model using least squares. To do this, write a program that does the following with participants. The program should: Find the differences between the y-values of the data points and the associated y-values on the line. Square the differences. Sum the squares. Display the sum. To do this, the participant should first put the data in List 1 (x-values) and List 2 (y-values) and the first guess of a trend line in the function grapher (y=). Help participants write the program, using questions like the following: • How do you denote the difference between a point’s y-value and the function’s y-value? [Given the point (L1, L2) and the function y1, the difference is denoted L2 − y1( L1) .] • Where should we put those differences? [Store the difference in List 3.] • What do we need to do with the differences? [Square them, (List 3)2] • Where should we put those squares? [Store the squares in List 4.] • What do we need to do with the squares? [Sum them, sum(List 4)] • What do we want to do with the sum of the squares once it is calculated? [See it on the calculator screen. Display the sum.] Using the following data, here is a sample of how you can demonstrate the program: Enter the data. Graph the data. Propose a trend line and find the sum of squares. Adjust the trend line and try for a smaller sum. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 237 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Adjust the trend line again and try for a smaller sum. Adjust the trend line again and try for a smaller sum. When you are satisfied with your accuracy, when you have minimized the sum of squares, then you have a reasonable fit for your data. A line of best fit is the line that minimizes the sum of squares. Try to minimize the sum of squares to get the best fit you can. Activity 2: Line of Best Fit Have participants work through the activity in groups, comparing their trend lines and sums of squares with each other in their group. 1. Enter the data 2. Enter a trend line. 3. Use the program to find the sum of squares. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 238 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Repeat to find better and better trend lines as the sum of squares decreases. Equation y = 111 + 0.9 x y = 100 + 1.6 x y = 99.86 + 1.63 x Sum of Squares 3881 88 76.0252 Note that the person whose equation most closely matches the linear regression line of best fit shown below will have the least sum of squares. We will return back to this after the next activity. 5. Answers will vary. Discuss with participants the different processes used to find a trend line. In this activity, we looked for the smallest sum of squares. In the data collection activities originally we took first differences, estimated a rate of change and a starting point, and adjusted the function based on the graph. • How do these methods compare? • What different things do you learn from each method? • Which method do you think you will use in the rest of the institute? Why? Math Note: The least sum of squares that you find with the above program will vary dramatically from data set to data set. The more linear the data, the smaller the least sum of squares can be. The less linear the data is, the bigger the residuals will be, the larger the least sum of squares will be. Also, the nature of the data can affect the magnitude of the least sum of squares. For instance, if the data deals with relatively large numbers such as distances between planets, the least sum of squares will probably be a similarly large TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 239 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes number (unless, of course, the data is completely linear, in which case the sum of squares is zero.) Likewise, if the data deals with relatively small numbers such as the size of insect eyes, the least sum of squares will probably be a similarly small number. This is all about scale. The least square sums are not scale insensitive. So if you are measuring in centimeters versus meters, the sums of squares may be very different in magnitude. Activity 3: The Correlation Coefficient A big part of thinking algebraically is doing and undoing. Here we start with first differences and ask participants to make data sets based upon the given first differences. Here we again return to the idea that if a data set has constant first differences, it is linear. a. x 0 1 2 3 4 5 y 100 129 89 124 137 119 1. Sample data sets. Note: for each different first value, there will be a different data set. b. c. d. x y x y x y 0 0.2 0 -10 0 2000 29 -15 20 1 -14.8 1 10 1 2004 -40 21 8 2 6.2 2 18 2 2008 35 15 5 3 21.2 3 23 3 2012 13 -4 17 4 17.2 4 40 4 2016 -18 8 32 5 25.2 5 72 5 2020 4 4 4 4 4 2. 4. Not linear data, low r value Slightly more linear data, slightly higher but still low r value More linear, higher r value Exactly linear, r = 1 5. As the data is more linear, the r gets closer to 1. See the following note about data that correlates negatively. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 240 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Note that all of the r values shown above are positive. This is because the data correlated positively. If the data correlates negatively, the r values are negative. You can quickly demonstrate this by looking at data that correlates negatively. Note that r is close to –1. Data that is linear with a negative slope has an r close to –1. The same pattern holds true. That is that the more linear the data, the better a line will model the data. This is indicated by r close to 1, this time by r being close to –1.. In other words, if a linear function models the data well, you will have an r value close to 1. The next part of the activity examines the converse of this statement. 6. 7. Note that the second differences below are constant. This means that the data is quadratic, not linear. x y First Second Differences Differences 0 0 1 2 1 1 3 2 2 4 5 2 3 9 7 4 16 8. Just because you have r close to 1, you may not have found a good (an appropriate) model. The data above is quadratic, yet a linear model yields r close to 1. If you have a good model, the r will be close to 1. If you have a model that yields r close to 1, then you may or you may not have a good model. The correlation coefficient, r, measures the strength and direction of the linear associate between two variables. An underlying key to the discussion is that one must look at the data to see if a linear model is appropriate, and then interpret the r value in that context. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 241 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes Math note: Statisticians often find it useful to square the correlation coefficient, r. This statistic, called the coefficient of determination, is a measure of the proportion of total variation in the observed values of y (the dependent variable) that is explained by the observed values of x (the independent variable). The value of the coefficient of determination may vary from zero to one. A coefficient of determination of zero indicates that none of variation in the dependent variable is explained by the independent variable. On the other hand, a coefficient of determination of one indicates that 100% of the variation in y has been explained by the regression equation. Thus, if a researcher finds that there is a correlation coefficient of +0.5 between IQ and reading speed, then the r-squared value of 0.25 tells us that 25% of the variation in reading speed of the subjects is related to the individual IQ's. Note that this also means that 75% is related to other factors, so that much of reading speed is not accounted for by IQ. If r 2 is large (98%, 89%, etc.), the model is providing a good fit to the data and we can have confidence in its ability to predict. If r 2 is small (10%, 18%, 25%, etc.), the model is not providing a good fit. If the data fall perfectly all along a straight line, then the model is a perfect fit, and r 2 is 1.0. In general, the extent to which the data points are lined up along the line or scattered away from it determines the strength of the correlation r 2 . Keep in mind that while r 2 indicates the strength of correlation, one still requires r to indicate the direction of the correlation (+ or -). So, one needs both statistics to tell the whole story. Math Note: The value of r can vary, depending on the size of the data set. Larger data sets yield more confidence in the trend and therefore the model. A linear model can often fit reasonably well over a small set of data, but does not represent the trend over the long run behavior of the data. Teachers should use caution when using models to make predictions far from the data set, especially when the data set is small. Caution: It is suggested that you not become involved in a discussion of statistics. The intention in this activity is not to teach a statistics course. It is to caution teachers from making inferences about r that are not true and about lines of best fit when the model may not be appropriate. Discuss with participants the difference between trend lines and lines of best fit. • When in the institute did we find trend lines? • When in the institute did we find lines of best fit? • How do trend lines and lines of best fit compare? Note: Throughout the institute, we have found trend lines. We have used real life problem situations to develop the concepts of slope as a rate of change and y-intercept as a starting point. We have also used first differences to find rates of change and y-intercepts. Also, in the data collection activities, we used first TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 242 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Leaders’ Notes differences to estimate rates of change and y-intercepts for trend lines. We then adjusted the parameters to visually obtain a better fit. Our objectives in all of these activities finding and using trend lines was to build understanding of the linear function. Our objective was not to obtain a line of best fit in the easiest way. Had we entered table values into lists and found regression lines as “end-all” answers, we would have missed opportunities to learn about the attributes of linear functions. When and how to use regression models is a topic for discussion. Certainly calculator regression can be used effectively in the midst of a larger problem, where the objective is to use the regression model to learn about a concept. Teachers may have to wrestle with the fact that some students may know how to find regression models with technology before the teacher wants students to have that knowledge. Effective assessment is essential in provoking students to really think, using technology as a tool for understanding and not as a crutch that hinders further progress. Sample Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. A trend line is an estimate for a linear function to model a situation. It may or may not be a line of best fit. A line of best fit is the best linear function to model a situation, usually found by linear regression. In the case of perfectly linear data, it is simply the line that contains those points. 4. Enter the two points into lists as shown below and find the line that contains them by using linear regression. Note that the correlation coefficient is 1 or –1 because through any two points there is exactly one line. For example: find the equation of the line that contains (0, 0) and (1, 10). Find the equation of the line that contains (4.3, 20.4) and (5.1, -10.5) Summary: By looking at a geometric and numeric approach to finding lines of best fit by the method of least squares, participants gain added understanding of calculator linear regression models. Calculator linear regression should be used to further understanding of the linear model or as an intermediate step in a bigger problem. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 243 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Transparency Transparency: Least Squares This square represents ( y1 − f ( x1 ))2 for 2 point P1 (x1, y1) P6 } P2 } y int } P3 } P1 Slope -2 2 -2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond P5 P4 4 The differences between the y-values of the points and the function values of the line . Spring 2001 244 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Activity 1 Activity 1: Sums of Squares Write a program that will, step by step, find the sum of squares between a linear function and a data set. The program will: • Find the differences between the line and the y-values of the data points. • Square the differences. • Sum the squares. • Display the sum. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 245 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Activity 2 Activity 2: Lines of Best Fit Using your program and the following data, find a line of best fit. 1. Enter the data into lists in your calculator. x y 10 120 20 129 30 146 40 163 50 187 60 199 70 212 2. Enter a guess for a trend line into the function grapher in your calculator. 3. Use your program to find a line of best fit. Record your trend lines and the corresponding sums of squares: Equation Sum of Squares 4. Compare your equation and your least sum of squares with your group. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 246 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Activity 2 5. In your group, refer to the data collection activities in 2.1 Out For a Stretch. Enter a data set from one of the activities. Use your program to find a line of best fit. Compare that line with those from your group members. Also compare that line with the trend line you found when you first completed the activity. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 247 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Activity 3 Activity 3: The Correlation Coefficient 1. Construct a data set given the first differences shown. a. b. c. d. x y x y x y x y 0 0 0 0 29 -15 20 1 1 1 1 -40 21 8 2 2 2 2 35 15 5 3 3 3 3 13 -4 17 4 4 4 4 -18 8 32 5 5 5 5 2. Sketch a scatter plot of each data set above. a. b. c. 4 4 4 4 4 d. 3. What do you notice about the above scatter plots? What is the big visual picture in each of the above graphs? 4. Using linear regression on your calculator, find a line of best fit for each data set above. Record the equation of the line and the value of the correlation coefficient, r. a. b. c. d. 5. What is true about the value of r as the data becomes more linear? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 248 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Activity 3 Is the converse true? 6. Using the linear regression on your calculator, find a line of best fit for the data below. Note the value of the correlation coefficient, r. x 0 1 2 3 4 5 y 0 1 4 9 16 25 7. Find first differences and then second differences for the data above. What do you find? 8. If r is close to 1, have you necessarily found the most appropriate model? Why or why not? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 249 II. Linear Functions 2.2 Linear Regression: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. What is the difference between a trend line and a line of best fit? 2. When do you believe students should find trend lines and when should they find lines of best fit? 3. How can you use technology to enhance student understanding, without allowing the student to rely on the technology as a crutch with little understanding of what the technology is doing? 4. How can you use linear regression on your calculator to find the equation of the line between two points? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 250 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Leaders’ Notes 3.1 Solving Linear Equations Overview: Participants solve linear equations with concrete models and make connections between the concrete model, abstract, and symbolic representations. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.3.B) The student investigates methods for solving linear equations and inequalities using concrete models, graphs, and the properties of equality, selects a method, and solves the equations and inequalities. Terms: concrete model, addition property of equality, subtraction property of equality Materials: algebra tiles, overhead algebra tiles Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables with plenty of elbow room in groups of 3—4. “Why use algebra tiles? Manipulating algebra tiles combines an algebraic and a geometric approach to algebraic concepts using an array-multiplication model similar to that employed in many elementary school classrooms. Our experience leads us to believe that students benefit from seeing algebra concepts developed from such a geometric perspective. Furthermore, we believe that we reach a broader group of students by sequencing instruction from the concrete level, through the pictorial level, and finally to the abstract—or symbolic—level. Such sequencing gives students several modes, in addition to just abstract manipulations, that help them understand and solve algebraic problems. The algebra tiles give a frame of reference to students who are not abstract thinkers.” Leitze, Annette Ricks and Kitt, Nancy A., “Using Homemade Algebra Tiles to Develop Algebra and Prealgebra Concepts,” Mathematics Teacher, September, 2000, 462. Before learning to solve linear equations with algebra tiles, students should be familiar with the tiles, what the tiles represent, and the relationships that exist among the tile pieces. Students should recognize that color represents positive or negative quantities and that the shape of the tile determines the value it represents (unit, x, x 2 .) Students should also have experiences adding and subtracting integers and should understand the concept of “zero pairs.” A zero pair consists of a negative tile and a positive tile pair. Together their sum is zero. For example, a negative unit tile and a positive unit tile form a zero pair, and a positive x tile and a negative x tile form a zero pair, etc. Begin by explaining zero pairs. Lead participants through the following examples, emphasizing that to maintain equality, manipulations made on one side must also be made on the other side. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 251 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Leaders’ Notes Have participants solve x + 5 = 7 on their own and then discuss the two different algebra tile solution methods on Transparency 1. • Which method looks easier? Do you think that it always will be? [Participants may suggest that using the subtraction property of equality is easier. They may change their minds on the next example.] Have participants solve x + ( −4) = 3 on their own and then discuss the two different algebra tile solution methods on Transparency 1. Discuss the differences between using the addition property of equality and using the subtraction property of equality. The technique must match the symbolic representation of solutions. The goal is to help participants gain facility in seeing the connection between the two methods, choosing the most expedient method, and being able to perform either whenever called for. Math note: The addition property of equality: if a = b , then a + c = b + c . The subtraction property of equality: if a = b , then a − c = b − c . Activity 1: Concrete Models Work through one Exercise with participants, demonstrating the process of solving using tiles, drawing a sketch showing the manipulations, and writing the symbolic version. Sketches should not be tedious, but should be viewed as a bridge from the concrete to the symbolic. Eventually sketches will be used as mental representations to assist students in understanding the symbolic manipulation. Make sure that participants write the symbolic representation that matches their concrete manipulation. For example, if they remove 2 negative unit tiles then they should write −( −2) . If they add two positive unit tiles, they should write +2 . Have participants work in pairs to complete the activity. One participant manipulates the tiles and the other participant records the actions on paper. Participants should switch roles periodically. One possible sequence is shown for each Exercise. Note that in the example answers, the addition property of equality is used. This is primarily for consistency and is not the only or necessarily the most expedient way. Discuss both ways with participants. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 252 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Leaders’ Notes 1. Sample solution: 4 x + 8 + ( −4 x ) = 5 x + 4 + ( −4 x ) 4 x + 8 = 5x + 4 8= x+4 8 + ( −4) = x + 4 + ( −4) 4=x 2. Sample solution: 11 = 3 x + 2 x + 20 − x − 9 = 7 x + 2 − 4 x 11 + ( −2) = 3 x + 2 + ( −2) 9 = 3x 3= x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 253 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Leaders’ Notes 3. Sample solution: x = −x + 1 x + 7 + ( −7) = 4 x + 3 − 5 x − 2 x + x = −x + 1 + x 2x = 1 x= 1 2 Activity 2: Using Concrete Models Have the participants work through the activity. Have a participant work through an exercise using overhead tiles. Ask another participant to quickly demonstrate a different way to manipulate the tiles to solve the same problem. Continue with the other exercises. 1. Sample solution: 8 x − 12 + ( −3 x ) = 3 x + 13 + ( −3 x ) 8 x − 12 = 3 x + 13 5 x − 12 + 12 = 13 + 12 5 x = 25 x=5 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 254 II. Linear Functions 2. 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Leaders’ Notes Sample solution: x − 6 = −x − 6 x − 6 = 2 x + 4 − 3 x − 10 x = −x x − 6 + 6 = −x − 6 + 6 At this point in the problem, x = − x , you can ask, • What number equals its opposite? [Zero, 0 = −0 , therefore x = 0 .] An alternative method is to add a positive x tile to both sides, resulting in 2 x = 0 . Therefore each x tile is equal to zero. 3. Sample solution: 3 x + 7 − (3 − x ) = ( x + 2 ) + x 4x + 4 = 2x + 2 2x + 4 = 2 4 x + 4 + ( −2 x ) = 2 x + 2 + ( −2 x ) 2 x + 4 + ( −4) = 2 + ( −4) 2 x = −2 x = −1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 255 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Leaders’ Notes 4. Sample solution: − x − 10 = x + 2 2 x − 9 − (3 x + 1) = 5 x − ( 4 x − 2) −10 = 2 x + 2 − x − 10 + x = x + 2 + x −10 + ( −2) = 2 x + 2 + ( −2) −12 = 2x −6 = x You may need some additional examples, depending on the level of your participants. • What are some ways that you used to record the algebra tiles? [Some teachers use dots and lines, some use circles and ovals, etc. Have participants share their recording strategies. Suggest that participants help students use the drawings as a bridge from the concrete tiles to the abstract algebraic notation.] Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. See Transparency 2 for an example. 2. See Transparency 1 for an example. 3. Answers will vary. Summary: Students come to algebra classes with varied backgrounds and learning styles. Using concrete models to introduce and support algebraic solution strategies bridges the gap between student informal understanding to abstract understanding. Sequencing instruction from the concrete, through the pictorial, to the abstract gives students several ways to understand algebraic problems. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 256 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Transparency 1 Transparency 1: x + 5 = 7 Algebra tile solution of x + 5 = 7, using the addition property of equality Algebra tile solution of x + 5 = 7, using the subtraction property of equality x+5= 7 x+5= 7 x + 5 + ( −5) = 7 + ( −5) x +5−5 = 7−5 x=2 x=2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 257 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Transparency 2 Transparency 2: x + ( −4) = 3 Algebra tile solution of x + ( −4) = 3, using the addition property of equality Algebra tile solution of x + ( −4) = 3, using the subtraction property of equality x + ( −4) = 3 x + ( −4) = 3 You do not have –4 to subtract from both sides, so add 4 zero pairs. x + ( −4) + 4 = 3 + 4 x + ( −4) = 3 + 4 + ( −4) x=7 x + ( −4) − ( −4) = 7 + ( −4) − ( −4) x=7 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 258 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Activity 1 Activity 1: Concrete Models Use algebra tiles to solve each equation. Sketch each step and record the symbolic representation for each step. 1. ____________________ original equation TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 259 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Activity 1 2. ____________________ original equation TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 260 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Activity 1 3. ____________________ original equation TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 261 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Activity 2 Activity 2: Using Concrete Models Build each equation and solve with algebra tiles. Record the intermediate steps and the solution. 1. 8 x − 12 = 3 x + 13 2. −6 + x = 2 x + 4 − 3 x − 10 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 262 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Activity 2 3. 3 x + 7 − (3 − x ) = ( x + 2) + x 4. 2 x − 9 − (3 x + 1) = 5 x − ( 4 x − 2) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 263 II. Linear Functions 3.1 Solving Linear Equations: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Write an equation that is readily solved with an algebra tile set, and: 1. is more easily solved using the addition property of equality. 2. is more easily solved using the subtraction property of equality. 3. What are your classroom goals for using tiles? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 264 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 3.2 Stays the Same Overview: Participants solve linear equations in one variable, making connections between algebraic solution steps, algebra tile solution steps, and graphical solution steps. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.3.B) The student investigates methods for solving linear equations and inequalities using concrete models, graphs, and the properties of equality, selects a method, and solves the equations and inequalities. Terms: algebraic solution method, algebra tile solution method Materials: algebra tiles, overhead algebra tiles, graphing calculators, 1” grid paper, markers Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. The big idea in this activity is that just as each algebraic step in solving a linear equation can be modeled with algebra tiles, each algebraic step can be modeled with a graphic representation. As you graph each side of a resulting equation in the solving process, the x-value of the intersection point remains the same. This is because the solution to each resulting equation in the solving process has the same solution. In other words, equivalent equations have the same solution. This is an important connection. Work through the following example with participants on the overhead projector with the algebra tiles and on the overhead calculator. Example: 5 + x = 3 x + 1 5 + x = 3x + 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond [0, 4.7] [0, 10] WINDOW Spring 2001 265 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 5 + x + (− x ) = 3x + 1 + (− x ) • What remains the same? [The xcoordinate of the intersection points. This is the solution, x = 2 , to both equations: the original and the equivalent equation.] • What remains the same? [The xcoordinate of the intersection points, which is the solution to each equivalent equation, x = 2 .] 5 = 2x + 1 5 + ( −1) = 2 x + 1 + ( −1) 4 = 2x 2=x (You can use a vertical line to show that each intersection point has the same xvalue.) • What remained the same throughout the entire solving process? [The xcoordinate of the intersection points, which is the solution to each equivalent equation, x = 2 .] • Could we have solved the equation in a different way? [Yes, in a few different ways. For example, you could have added –5 to both sides first.] • Would solving the equation differently change the solution to the equation? [No.] • Would it change the resulting graphs? [Yes.] Work through the following example to demonstrate how solving the problem in a different way changes the way the graph looks, but the x-coordinate of the resulting intersection points remain the same, x = 2 .] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 266 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 5 + x = 3x + 1 [0, 4.7] [-8, 10] WINDOW 5 + x + ( −5) = 3 x + 1 + ( −5) x = 3x − 4 x + ( −3 x ) = 3 x − 4 + ( −3 x ) −2 x = −4 • − x = −2 If the opposite of x is –2, − x = −2 , then what is x? x = 2. x=2 Activity: Stays the Same Have participants work on the activity in their small group. Use the model just completed by everyone. Assign one of the Exercises to each group, and have each group make a poster size presentation on 1” grid paper of the graphical results of their Exercise. They should list the algebraic steps and sketch the corresponding lines in one appropriate window. You might suggest that they use a different color for TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 267 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes each step and sketch the corresponding lines in the same color. Then have them make a second poster size presentation, showing the same Exercise, but with the equation solved in a different order, thus obtaining different graphs, all with the same x-coordinate for the relevant intersection points. Have participants present their work to the rest of the group. • • • • • Did anyone solve this Exercise different from the two shown by this group? [If so, briefly describe the results.] What connections does this activity build? What are some of the important concepts or ideas that you want students to understand as a result of this activity? How might students view the algebraic solution method differently after completing this activity? How do you think this activity might impact how you teach solving one variable linear equations? One way of completing each exercise follows. There are many other correct ways. 1. A sample solution: 7 + 3 x = −8 − 2 x [-4.7, 4.7] [-20, 3.1] (−7) + 7 + 3x = ( −7) − 8 − 2 x 3 x = −15 − 2 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 268 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 3 x + 2 x = −15 − 2 x + 2 x 5 x = −15 x = −3 2. A sample solution: x + 5 =1− x [-4.7, 4.7] [-7, 5] x + 5 + x =1− x + x 2x + 5 = 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 269 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 2 x + 5 + ( −5) = 1 + ( −5) 2 x = −4 x = −2 3. A sample solution: 3 − 2x = x − 6 [-4.7, 4.7] [-6, 10] 3 − 2x + 6 = x − 6 + 6 −2 x + 9 = x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 270 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 2x − 2x + 9 = 2x + x 9 = 3x 3= x 4. A sample solution: −2 x + 4 = −5 + 4 x [-4.7, 4.7] [-3.1, 11] −2 x + 4 + 2 x = −5 + 4 x + 2 x 4 = −5 + 6 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 271 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes 4 + 5 = −5 + 5 + 6 x 9 = 6x 3 =x 2 Answers to Reflect and Apply: 1. The original equation is −2 − 6 x = 3 − x . −2 − 6 x = 3 − x −2 − 6 x + 2 = 3 − x + 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 272 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Leaders’ Notes −6 x = 5 − x −6 x + x = 5 − x + x −5 x = 5 x = −1 Summary: Building on the work for solving one variable equations with concrete models (algebra tiles), participants make connections between the concrete model, the algebraic solution method, and a graphical look at the steps involved in each. Just as the solution to equivalent equations is the same, so too is the xcoordinate of the intersection points when the equivalent equations are graphed. This gives teachers one more way to meet all of the learning styles present in their classrooms. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 273 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Activity Activity: Stays the Same Solve each of the following problems, showing each step, in the three ways below. Sketch the algebra tile solution and the graphical solution. 1. 7 + 3 x = −8 − 2 x Algebra Tile Solution: Algebraic Solution: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Graphic Solution: 274 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Activity 2. x + 5 = 1 − x Algebra Tile Solution: Algebraic Solution: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Graphic Solution: 275 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Activity 3. 3 − 2 x = x − 6 Algebra Tile Solution: Algebraic Solution: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Graphic Solution: 276 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Activity 4. −2 x + 4 = −5 + 4 x Algebra Tile Solution: Algebraic Solution: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Graphic Solution: 277 II. Linear Functions 3.2 Stays the Same: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Fill in the missing steps below: Algebra Tile Algebraic Solution: Solution: Graphic Solution: 2. Write a linear equation that: • has an integer solution, • can be solved with one algebra tile set, and • whose solution can be found graphically in the window [-10,10] [-10, 10]. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 278 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities Overview: Participants use problem situations and technology to explore linear inequalities. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.3.A) The student analyzes situations involving linear functions and formulates linear equations or inequalities to solve problems. (c.3.B) The student investigates methods for solving linear equations and inequalities using concrete models, graphs, and the properties of equality, selects a method, and solves the equations and inequalities. (c.3.C) For given contexts, the student interprets and determines the reasonableness of solutions to linear equations and inequalities. Terms: linear inequality, strict inequality Materials: transparencies of the Student Activity: Age Estimates from 2.1.1 The Linear Parent Function, graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity 1: Linear Inequalities in One Variable Many of the problem situations explored throughout the institute have focused on situations in which linear equations were solved. Many of those linear equations, however, could very well have been considered linear inequalities. Ask participants to recall some of these problem situations that could have been considered as linear inequalities. Have participants work through the activity. Circulate and ask guiding questions. Discuss their results, using the following answers as a guide. 1. 5 + 4 x 2. 5 + 4 x ≤ 50 3. A tabular approach: the y-values are less than or equal to 50. For these x-values and less, so, x ≤ 11.25 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 279 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 4. Algebraic: 5 + 4 x ≤ 50 Graphic: When is this line, y = 5 + 4 x , less than , or under, this line, y = 50 ? In other words, for what x-values is the diagonal line under the horizontal line? Answer: for these x-values 4 x ≤ 45 x ≤ 11.25 11.25 Note that the graphing calculator makes no distinction between inequalities and strict inequalities. Participants will use the same graph on the graphing calculator to find or confirm solutions for both inequalities and strict inequalities. 5. 15 + 3 x 6. 5 + 4 x ≤ 15 + 3 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 280 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 7. A sample solution. Algebraic: 5 + 4 x ≤ 15 + 3 x Graphic: 5 + x ≤ 15 4 x ≤ 10 + 3 x x ≤ 10 x ≤ 10 10 Discuss how using multiple representations for solving linear inequalities makes connections and develops understanding. • How does the solution to a linear equation differ from the solution to a linear inequality? [The solution to a linear equation is one value, one location on the number line. The solution to a linear inequality is an infinite set of values.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 281 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes Extension: Boolean Algebra and Inequalities Many graphing calculators have the capability to use Boolean algebra on the home screen and/or with graphing to support solution sets of linear inequalities. On the home screen, inequalities produce either a True = 1 or a False = 0 as follows. You can demonstrate what happens when you add to or multiply both sides of an inequality as follows: Using the Boolean and graphing features, have participant investigate 4 x + 5 ≤ 50 , first on the home screen as follows: You can also investigate 4 x + 5 ≤ 50 by graphing. The calculator graphs y = 1 when 4 x + 5 ≤ 50 and it graphs y = 0 when 4 x + 5 ≤ 50 . • What are the implications for assessment when students understand how to graph solution sets as shown above? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 282 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes Activity 2: Linear Inequalities in Two Variables Show participants the transparencies of the Student Activity: Age Estimates from 2.1.1 The Linear Parent Function. • What were the big ideas in the activity? [Guessed famous people’s ages, graphed the scatter plot of (guess, actual age), discussed the line y = x , over-guessing, and under-guessing.] Have participants work on Exercises 1 – 4. Circulate and ask guiding questions. Discuss results. 1. All ordered pairs representing over-guesses are under and not including the line y = x and do not include the line itself. 2. Represent the shaded set with y < x . • How can you graph y < x on your graphing calculator? [Help participants with individual calculators.] 3. All of the ordered pairs representing under-guesses are above, not including, the line y = x . 4. Represent the shaded set with y > x . • How can you graph y > x on your graphing calculator? [Help participants with individual calculators.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 283 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes Work through the rest of the activity with participants. Discuss the scenario, demonstrating free-throws, 2-point field goals, and 3-point field goals, if necessary. Emphasize that the situation will only consider 2- and 3-point shots and the total combined score for Friday’s game. 5. Ask participants to fill in the table. After participants have filled in most of their table, ask for some suggestions from the group and write them on the Activity transparency. Make sure to include some examples that give a combined score of more than 63. Sample entries Score for 2-point Score for 3-point Total Score Shots Shots 24(2) 5(3) 63 20(2) 10(3) 70 0(2) 21(3) 63 31(2) 1(3) 63 40(2) 15(3) 125 • • How did you get the total score? [Multiply 2 times the number of 2point shots and add to the product of 3 times the number of 3-point shots, 2 x + 3 y .] How did you know if your choices for numbers of shots fit the problem situation ? [If the total score was greater than or equal to 63.] 6. 2 x + 3 y ≥ 63 2 7. a. y ≥ 21 − x 3 2 x 3 c. Use a friendly window for your calculator so that cursor has integer values. b. Graph y = 21 − Each ordered pair listed in the table lies above the line y = 21 − TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 2 x. 3 284 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes d. Randomly choose some non-integer points above and below the line. Use mental math to decide if the point satisfies the inequality or check on the home screen as shown: This ordered pair works because 82.5 > 63. This is a non-example because 39.5 < 63. This ordered pair works because 71.5 > 63. Again, each ordered pair that works lies above the line 2 y = 21 − x . 3 e. To satisfy both the problem situation and the inequality, the points 2 must lie above the line y = 21 − x . 3 f. Help participants with individual calculators. g. The solution set for y ≥ 21 − 2 x is the set of ordered pairs that lie 3 2 x. 3 h. Use the free-floating cursor to demonstrate that for that specific xvalue, the y-values of the ordered pairs in the solution set are all greater than the y-value of the line (Use trace to get the y-value of the line.) above the line y = 21 − TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 285 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 8. a. The solution set for y ≥ 21 − 2 x is the set of ordered pairs that lie 3 2 x. 3 b. Then use the free-floating cursor to demonstrate that for that specific x-value, the y-values of the ordered pairs in the solution set are all greater than the y-value of the line (Use trace to get the y-value of the line.) above the line y = 21 − Answers to Reflect and Apply Have participants look for general descriptions of the solution(s) for the problems, not specific solution(s). See the answers for below for examples. 1. 13 = 3 x − 5 : The solution to a linear equation in one variable is x = a , which is represented graphically by one location on the number line. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 286 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 2. 13 > 3 x − 5 : The solution to this strict linear inequality in one variable is x < a , which is represented graphically by a subset of the number line. The solution is all x-values where the line y = 13 is above the line y = 3x − 5 . 3. 13 < 3 x − 5 : The solution to this strict linear inequality in one variable is x > a , which is represented graphically by a subset of the number line. The solution is all x-values where the line y = 13 is under the line y = 3x − 5 . 4. y > 3 x − 5 : The solution to this strict linear inequality in two variables is the infinite set of ordered pairs that comprise the section of the plane above the line y = 3 x − 5 . 5. y < 3 x − 5 : The solution to this strict linear inequality in two variables is the infinite set of ordered pairs that comprise the section of the plane below the line y = 3 x − 5 . Summary: Just as linear functions and linear equations can be developed using problem situations from life, so can linear inequalities. Linear inequalities in one variable have solutions in one dimension, which are sets of numbers, and linear inequalities in two variables have solutions in two dimensions, which are sets of ordered pairs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 287 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Activity 1 Activity 1: Linear Inequalities in One Variable Bianca and Joe are starting their own pet grooming business called Bianca and Joe’s. They have figured that they can spend no more than $50 a month on flea shampoo. Joe has found a local dealer of pet shampoo, The Pet Pantry, who sells quart bottles for $4.00 a bottle plus a $5.00 handling fee per order. 1. Write an expression that represents the amount of money charged by The Pet Pantry for an order of shampoo. 2. Write an inequality that represents the amount Bianca and Joe’s is willing to pay per month for The Pet Pantry’s shampoo. 3. Solve the inequality using the table on your calculator. 4. Solve the inequality algebraically step by step. Next to each step, show the graphical solution. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 288 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Activity 1 Bianca is wondering if they can save money by shopping around. She found another local dealer, The Canine Corner, who sells the shampoo for $3.00 a quart bottle plus a $15.00 handling charge per order. 5. Write an expression that represents the amount of money charged by The Canine Corner for an order of shampoo. 6. Write an inequality that represents when it is less expensive to buy an order with The Pet Pantry compared to The Canine Corner. 7. Solve the inequality algebraically step by step. Next to each step, show the graphical solution. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 289 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Activity 2 Activity 2: Linear Inequalities in Two Variables Recall the Student Activity “Age Estimates” from 2.1.1 The Linear Parent Function. You estimated the age of famous people and graphed the scatter plot (my guess, actual age). Actual 1. On the graph below, shade the region that contains the ordered pairs representing the over-guesses possible for the activity. 2. How can you represent the shaded set with an inequality? Guess Actual 3. On the graph below, shade the region that contains the ordered pairs representing the under-guesses possible for the activity. 4. How can you represent the shaded set with an inequality? Guess TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 290 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Activity 2 The Stars basketball team never makes a free-throw. Considering only 2-point and 3-point shots, what possible combination of shots could they score in Friday’s basketball game to meet or beat their season average score of 63 points? 5. Investigate numerically some combinations of shots that would meet or beat their season average of 63. Score for 2-point Shots Score for 3-point Shots Total Score 6. Write an inequality in two variables that represents the situation. 7. Solve the inequality graphically: a. Solve for y. b. On your graphing calculator graph the line y = ____________ . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 291 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Activity 2 c. Use the free-floating cursor to find the ordered pairs listed in your table above. Where do these ordered pairs lie on the graph? d. Use the free floating cursor to find points that satisfy 2 y ≥ 21 − x and the problem situation. Where are these 3 points? e. Use the free floating cursor to find other points that satisfy 2 y ≥ 21 − x , but not the problem situation. Where are 3 these points? 2 f. Shade on your graphing calculator y ≥ 21 − x . Sketch. 3 g. Use the word “over” or “under” to describe the solution 2 2 set for y ≥ 21 − x in terms of the line y = 21 − x . 3 3 h. For a specific x-value, how do the y-values of the ordered pairs in the solution set compare to the y-value of the line? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 292 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Activity 2 8. Suppose the problem situation had called for the inequality, 2 y ≤ 21 − x . Predict the graph and produce it on your 3 graphing calculator. Sketch. a. Use the word “over” or “under” to describe the solution 2 2 set for y ≤ 21 − x in terms of the line y = 21 − x . 3 3 b. For a specific x-value, how do the y-values of the ordered pairs in the solution set compare to the y-value on the line? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 293 II. Linear Functions 3.3 Solving Linear Inequalities: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Describe the general solution(s) to the following. Do not solve for specific solutions. 1. 13 = 3 x − 5 2. 13 > 3 x − 5 3. 13 < 3 x − 5 4. y > 3 x − 5 5. y < 3 x − 5 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 294 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities Overview: Participants use a table to develop a system of linear inequalities. They solve the system using various methods and make connections between a system of inequalities and a system of equations. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.4.A) The student analyzes situations and formulates systems of linear equations to solve problems. (c.4.B) The student solves systems of linear equations using concrete models, graphs, tables, and algebraic methods. (c.4.C) For given contexts, the student interprets and determines the reasonableness of solutions to systems of linear equations. Terms: system of linear equations, system of linear inequalities Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Note: Systems of linear inequalities is not an Algebra I TEKS , but is an Algebra II TEKS. We use a system of inequalities in this activity to stretch teacher understanding. Using a situation that describes a system of linear inequalities lends itself well to developing the system in a table. Activity 1: Using a Table Describe the scenario of the scout group going to the movies. Have participants fill in a few rows of the table. Some participants may interpret the problem to mean that exactly 10 people will go to the show or that they must spend exactly $45. Clarify that they can take any number of people up to and including 10 as long as they spend $45 or less. • What factors might the troop consider when deciding how many adults and children will go to the movies? [Sample Answers. The troop may want to consider the best adult-child ratio, or they may want the most number of children to go to the movie. Perhaps the adults want to get out of the heat and see the movie.] Ask for some examples and fill in the table on the transparency. Ask for at least one example that someone tried that did not work. Record it and draw a line through it as shown below. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 295 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes Number of Adults 2 5 1 2 3 x Number of children 4 5 9 8 7 y Total number of people 6 10 10 10 10 x + y ≤ 10 Cost for Adults 2(6) 5(6) 1(6) 2(6) 3(6) 6x Cost for Children 4(3.50) 5(3.50) 9(3.50) 8(3.50) 7(3.50) 3.5y Total Cost 26 47.50 37.50 40 42.50 6 x + 3.5 y ≤ 45 Ask participants to look for patterns in the table. Help them use their patterns to develop the inequalities in the last row of the table, using the questions below. • How did you find the total number of people? [Add the number of adults and the number of children.] • How can we write this symbolically? [If x is the number of adults (fill in the first box with x) and y is the number of children (fill in the second box with y) then the total number of people is x + y ≤ 10 .] • How did you find the cost for the adults? [Multiply the number of adults times 6, or 6x .] • How did you find the cost for the children? [Multiply the number of children times 3.5, or 3.5 y .] • How did you find the total cost? [Add the cost for the adults, 6x, and the cost for the children , 3.5y.] • How did you know if that met the requirement? [It had to be less than $45.] • How can you write this as an inequality? [The sum of the cost for the adults, 6x, and the cost for the children, 3.5y, must be less than 45, 6 x + 3.5 y ≤ 45 .] Have participants write the system of inequalities below the table. x + y ≤ 10 6 x + 3.5 y ≤ 45 Activity 2: Solve the System Graphically Lead the participants with the overhead calculator through the activity using the following suggestions. 1. To graph x + y ≤ 10 , solve for y and graph y = 10 − x . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 296 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes Use the free floating cursor to find points that satisfy y ≤ 10 − x . Look for points under the line y = 10 − x . Use mental math to check that sum of the x-coordinate and the y-coordinate is less than or equal to 10. • Where do the solutions to the equality, y = 10 − x , exist? [The solutions are the ordered pairs, the set of which is the line y = 10 − x . In other words, the solutions lie on the line y = 10 − x .] • How can you verify your answer? [Trace to points on the line to confirm that the sum of the x-coordinate and the y-coordinate is equal to 10.] Move the cursor around and discuss. • Which of the above satisfy the problem situation? [Only the first ordered pair found above. The second screen, which shows the ordered pair (1, 5.2) satisfies the inequality but not the problem situation as you cannot take 5.2 people to the movie. The third screen, which shows the ordered pair (-2.2, 2.2) again satisfies the inequality, but not the problem situation as you cannot have negative people.] Shade y ≤ 10 − x • What do the shaded points represent? [Each ordered pair represents (number of adults, number of children) such that no more than 10 people go to the movie.] 2. To graph 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 , solve for y and graph y = TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 45 6 − x. 3.5 3.5 297 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes Use the free floating cursor to find points that satisfy y ≤ Look for points under the line y = • 45 6 − x. 3.5 3.5 Which of the above satisfy the problem situation? [Only the first ordered pair found above because 5 adults and 2 children satisfy both conditions of having less than 10 people and costing less than $45. The second screen, which shows the ordered pair (4, 0.6) satisfies the inequality but not the problem situation as you cannot take 0.6 people to the movie. The third screen, which shows the ordered pair 4, -1) does satisfy the inequality, but not the problem situation as you cannot have negative people.] Shade for y ≤ • 45 6 − x. 3.5 3.5 45 6 − x 3.5 3.5 What do the shaded points represent? [Each ordered pair represents (number of adults, number of children) such that the total cost is no more than $45.] 3. Graph the system of equations and the solution. • What does this solution represent? [The solution (4, 6) represents the number of adults, 4, and the number of children, 6, to go to the movie such that the price will be exactly $45.] Graph the system of inequalities. The solution is the double shaded section. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 298 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes • • Where is the solution to the system of inequalities? [The double shaded region.] What does the solution to the system of inequalities, the points in the double shaded section, represent? [The solution (x, y) represents the number of adults, x, and the number of children, y, to go to the movie such that no more than 10 people will go and the price will be no more than $45.] Use the free floating cursor to discuss various points as follows: • Do the points satisfy the system and/ or the problem situation and why? This point (2, 5) means that 2 adults and 5 children go. It satisfies the system and the problem situation because 2 + 5 < 10 and 2(6) + 5(3.5) < 45 . This point (1, 10) means that 1 adult and 10 children go. It does not satisfy the problem situation because you cannot take 11 people. It does not satisfy the system because 1 + 10 < 10 . This point (-3, 2) does not satisfy the problem situation because you cannot have a negative number of adults. It does satisfy the system because −3 + 2 < 10 and −3(6) + 2(3.5) < 45 . This point (2, -1) does not satisfy the problem situation because you cannot have a negative number of scouts. It does satisfy the system because 2 + ( −1) < 10 and 2(6) + ( −1)(3.5) < 45 . • What is the relationship between the sets, the set that satisfies the problem situation and the set that is the solution to the system of TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 299 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes inequalities? [All of the points that satisfy the problem situation are in the set that is the solution to the system of inequalities. The solution to the system of inequalities contains many other points. The solution to the system includes points in the second and third quadrants, none of which satisfy the problem situation. Also the solution to the system includes all of the non-integer ordered pairs bounded by the two inequalities. The problem situation includes only natural number values in the ordered pairs.] Activity 3: Solve the System Symbolically Have participants solve the system using any algebraic methods they choose. Ask participant to consider the following question while they are solving. • How does the algebraic solution to the system of equations relate to the graphical solution of the system of inequalities? 1. Solve using substitution x + y = 10 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 Solve for y: y = 10 − x Substitute: 6 x + 3.5(10 − x ) = 45 Solve for x: 6 x + 35 − 3.5 x = 45 2.5 x = 10 x=4 Substitute to find y: y = 10 − 4 y=6 The solution is (4, 6) Solve using linear combination (elimination) x + y = 10 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 Multiply −6( x + y = 10) Add to 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 − 6 x − 6 y = −60 + 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 − 2.5 y = −15 y=6 Substitute to find x: x = 10 − 6 x=4 The solution is (4, 6) 2. The solution to the system of linear equations is an ordered pair, the intersection of the two lines. The solution is written as an ordered pair (x, y). The solution to the system of linear inequalities is a set of ordered pairs. The solution is drawn as a graph that represents all of the ordered pairs contained in the intersection of the shaded regions. Answers to Reflect and Apply Explain to participants that we are looking for general descriptions of the solution(s) for the problems, not specific solution(s). See the answers for below for examples. 1. 13 = 3 x − 5 : The solution to a linear equation in one variable is x = a , which is represented graphically by one location on the number line. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 300 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Leaders’ Notes 2. 13 > 3 x − 5 : The solution to this strict linear inequality in one variable is x < a , which is represented graphically by a subset of the number line. The solution is all of the x-values where the line y = 13 is above the line y = 3x − 5 . 3. y > 3 x − 5 : The solution to this strict linear inequality in two variables is the set of ordered pairs that comprise the section of the plane above the line y = 3 x − 5 . 4. 3 x − y = 13 x + y = 11 : The solution to a system of linear equations can be the intersection point if the lines intersect, a line if the equations of the lines represent the same line, or there can be no solution if the lines are parallel. 5. 3 x − y > 13 x + y < 11: The solution to a system of linear inequalities is the intersection of the two inequalities. It is a set of ordered pairs if the intersection set is not empty. It is represented by the double shaded area. 6. Answers will vary. An example: Here is a question from a recent End of Course Algebra I test: A truck is carrying 1500 pounds of cargo that occupies 138 cubic feet of space. A television weighs 50 pounds and occupies a space of 4 cubic feet. A microwave oven weighs 30 pounds and occupies a space of 3 cubic feet. Which system of equations can be used to find the total number of televisions, t, and microwaves, m, that are in the truck? Changed to inequality problem: A truck is carrying at most 1500 pounds of cargo that occupies at least 138 cubic feet of space. A television weighs 50 pounds and occupies a space of 4 cubic feet. A microwave oven weighs 30 pounds and occupies a space of 3 cubic feet. Which system of equations can be used to find the total number of televisions, t, and microwaves, m, that are in the truck? 59t + 30 m ≤ 1500 4t + 3m ≥ 138 A good window: [0, 60] [0, 40] Summary: Building on the work of solving equations and inequalities, we end the section with solving systems of equations and systems of inequalities. A table is used to build the linear inequalities from the written situation. Solving the system step by step graphically builds understanding of systems of equations and inequalities. We make the distinction between the solution to a system of linear equations as being an ordered pair, the intersection point, and the solution to a system of linear inequalities as being a set of ordered pairs. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 301 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Activity 1 Activity 1: Using a Table A local scout troop and leaders are going to a movie. • A maximum of 10 people can go. • They can spend $45 or less for the admission price. • The movie theater charges $6.00 per adult and $3.50 per child. Use the table to investigate possible combinations of people that satisfy the conditions. Number Number Total Cost for of Adults of number Adults children of people TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Cost for Children Total Cost 302 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Activity 2 Activity 2: Solve the System Graphically x + y ≤ 10 6 x + 3.5 y ≤ 45 1. Solve x + y ≤ 10 graphically. 2. Solve 6 x + 3.5 y ≤ 45 graphically. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 303 II. Linear Functions 3. Consider the system 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Activity 2 x + y ≤ 10 6 x + 3.5 y ≤ 45 • Graph the system of equations: x + y = 10 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 • Find the solution to the system of equations graphically. • Graph the solution to the system of inequalities. • What part of the solution to the system of inequalities makes sense in the problem situation? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 304 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Activity 3 Activity 3: Solve the System Symbolically 1. Solve the system of equations symbolically using at least 2 different methods. x + y = 10 6 x + 3.5 y = 45 2. How does the solution for the system of equations compare to the solution for the system of inequalities? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 305 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Describe in general the solution(s) to the following. 1. 13 = 3 x − 5 2. 13 > 3 x − 5 3. y > 3 x − 5 4. 3 x − y = 13 x + y = 11 5. 3 x − y > 13 x + y < 11 6. Create a problem that results in a system of inequalities. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 306 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Student Activity: Concrete Models and Systems of Linear Equations Overview: Students use concrete models to solve a system of linear equations. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.4.B) The student solves systems of linear equations using concrete models, graphs, tables, and algebraic methods. Terms: system of linear equations Materials: algebra tiles Procedures: Students should be seated with plenty of elbow room to work with the algebra tiles. Work through the following example with students. Explain that you need to choose one tile shape to represent the variable x, a different tile shape to represent the variable y, and a different tile shape to represent one unit. x= y= unit = Example: 3x + 4 y = 2 x − 4y = 6 3x + 4 y = 2 x − 4y = 6 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 307 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Add the two models together to eliminate the y terms. 3x + 4 y = 2 +( x − 4 y = 6) 4x = 8 x=2 Replace x with 2 in one of the original equations. 3x + 4 y = 2 , 3(2) + 4 y = 2 Solve for y. 6 + 4y = 2 (−6) + 6 + 4 y = 2 + ( −6) 4 y = −4 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 308 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity y = −1 So the solution is x = 2, y = −1 Now solve the system by substitution. 3x + 4 y = 2 x − 4y = 6 Solve for x. x − 4y + 4y = 6 + 4y x = 6 + 4y Substitute 6 + 4 y for x in 3 x + 4 y = 2 . 3(6 + 4 y) + 4 y =2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 309 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity 16 y + 18 + ( −18) = 2 + ( −18) 16 y = −16 y = −1 Substitute y = −1 in 3 x + 4 y = 2 . 3 x + 4( −1) = 2 3x − 4 = 2 3x − 4 + 4 = 2+4 3x = 6 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 310 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity x=2 So the solution is x = 2, y = −1 Have students complete the student activity and discuss. Activity: Concrete Models and Systems 1. An example of solving the system: x + 2y = 1 − x + 3y = 9 Add the two models together to eliminate the x terms. x + 2y = 1 + ( − x + 3 y = 9) 5 y = 10 y=2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 311 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Replace y with 2 units in one of the original equations. x + 2 y = 1, x + 2( 2 ) = 1 Solve for x. x + 4 =1 x + 4 + ( −4) = 1 + ( −4) x = −3 So the solution is x = −3, y = 2 2 x + 3y = 1 − x + 2 y = −4 In this case, the student solves by linear combination. 2. 2 x + 3y = 1 − x + 2 y = −4 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 312 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Multiply − x + 2 y = −4 by 2. 2( − x + 2 y = −4 ) −2 x + 4 y = −8 Add the two models together to eliminate the x terms. 2 x + 3y = 1 +( −2 x + 4 y = −8) 7 y = −7 y = −1 Replace y with -1 in one of the original equations. 2 x + 3 y = 1, 2 x + 3( −1) = 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 313 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Solve for x. 2x − 3 = 1 2x − 3 + 3 = 1+ 3 2x = 4 x=2 So the solution is x = 2, y = −1 2 x + 3y = 1 − x + 2 y = −4 In this case, the student solves by substitution. 2. 2 x + 3y = 1 − x + 2 y = −4 Solve − x + 2 y = −4 for x. −x + x + 2y + 4 = −4 + x + 4 2y + 4 = x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 314 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Substitute 2 y + 4 for x in 2 x + 3 y = 1. 2(2 y + 4) + 3y = 1 7y + 8 = 1 7 y + 8 + ( −8) = 1 + ( −8) 7 y = −7 so y = −1 Replace y with –1 in 2 x + 3 y = 1 2 x + 3( −1) = 1 2x − 3 = 1 2x − 3 + 3 = 1 + 3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 315 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity 2x = 4 x=2 So the solution is x = 2, y = −1 • Summary: How does solving with tiles help you understand the algebraic steps? Using concrete models to solve systems of linear equations helps students understand and make connections when using the linear combination (elimination) algebraic solution method. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 316 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity Student Activity: Concrete Models and Systems of Linear Equations 1. Solve the following system using algebra. Sketch each step and write the algebraic representation for each step. 3x + 4 y = 2 x − 4y = 6 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 317 II. Linear Functions 3.4 Systems of Linear Equations and Inequalities: Student Activity 2. Solve the following system using algebra tiles in two ways, by substitution and by linear combination. Sketch each step and write the algebraic representation for each step. 2 x + 3y = 1 − x + 2 y = −4 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 318 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes 1.1 Quadratic Relationships Overview: Participants use lists to develop a quadratic function representing the volume of a sandbox with a fixed depth. Using the quadratic function, participants solve quadratic equations numerically and graphically. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.2) The student understands there is more than one way to solve a quadratic equation and solves them using appropriate methods. (d.2.A) The student solves quadratic equations using concrete models, tables, graphs, and algebraic methods. (d.2.B) The student relates the solutions of quadratic equations to the roots of their functions. Terms: quadratic function, zero of a function, root of a function, solution of an equation Materials: graphing calculators, pieces of lumber or cardboard to simulate lumber Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity 1: Building a Sandbox Work through the activity with participants, using the overhead graphing calculator to demonstrate. Begin by discussing the situation of building a rectangular sandbox. Use the 1 foot wide lumber or cardboard to simulate a sandbox. 1. Have participants roughly sketch some possible sandboxes from a bird’s eye view. Examples: 14 8 1 7 11 4 • • • • • What is fixed in this situation? [Two things are fixed. The depth of the sandbox is 1 foot deep and the perimeter of the sandbox is 30.] How will you fill in the depth column? [The depth is fixed. It will always be 1 foot.} If the perimeter is 30, what kind of widths make sense for the situation? [Widths ranging from more than 0 feet to less than 15 feet.] How does the length relate to the width? [The length is always 15 − width .] How does the volume relate to the width and length? [The volume is the product of the width, length, and depth, v = w ∗ l ∗ d . In this case since the depth is always 1, v = w ∗ l ∗ 1 = w ∗ l ] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 319 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes 2. Sample dimensions: Width Length 2 13 4 11 6 9 8 7 10 5 12 3 14 1 Depth 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Volume 26 44 54 56 50 36 14 3. Encourage participants to predict the general shape of the graph. 4. Use the following to help participants enter the data into lists. Ask participants to put the table values for width into a list in the calculator. • How is the length related to the width? [The sum of the width and the length is always 15.] • How can you use an expression for the length in terms of the width to fill in the lengths into the list in your calculator. [ 15 − list 1.] • What is the depth of each sandbox? [Depth is always fixed at 1 foot.] • What expression can you use for volume? [ (list 1)(list 2) • 1.] Sample scatter plot: Note: Some calculators allow you to name lists. For this situation, you could name lists WIDTH, LENTH, and VOLUM. 5. (list 1)(list 2) • 1 6. Sample: Extension: Ask participants to predict how the situation and the graph would change if the depth of the sandbox is 1.5 feet instead of 1 foot. Change the volume function to be V = x(15 − x ) * 1.5 and graph. How would the situation TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 320 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes and the graph change if the depth of the sandbox is 0.75 feet. Again change the volume function to be V = x(15 − x ) * 0.75 and graph. This is an introduction to transformations, which will be explored in depth in 1.2 Transformations. Note: The purpose of the following questions, solving quadratic equations, is to familiarize participants with the different types of equations that arise from quadratic functions. One of the common struggles that students have is differentiating between questions that ask for an input value and questions that ask for an output value. We use some non-algebraic solution methods here to introduce quadratic equations. We want to build confidence in reading questions and solving equations with power of technology and students will then be able to solve symbolically with more understanding. Briefly discuss each of the solution methods shown below, emphasizing the power of multiple representations in promoting understanding. Graph: Table: Home screen: Using function notation on the home screen: 7. Solution: V = 38.1875 ft 3 • Does this question give an input value and ask for an output value or does the question give an output value and ask for an input value? [The question gives an input value, 3.25 feet, and asks for an output value, the volume. You could also use the terms domain and range in this question and answer.] 8. Solution: width = 7.5 ft You can do some work on the home screen to get a feel for the answer: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 321 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes Graph, using trace to get an Graph, using the calculator approximation: to find the maximum value: Table, looking for the x-value that yields the highest yvalue: • • Does this question give an input value and ask for an output value or does the question give an output value and ask for an input value? [The question gives an output value, the maximum volume, and asks for an input value, the width.] Where do we usually see a maximum question like this? [Traditionally, maximum and minimum problems have usually been reserved for calculus, but can readily be examined using technology in earlier courses. This kind of question naturally arises when studying quadratic functions.] 9. Solution: width = 5 ft,10 ft TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Graph, using trace to get an Graph, using trace to get an approximation for one approximation for the other solution: solution: Spring 2001 322 III. Nonlinear Functions Table: 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes Graph, using the calculator to get an exact answer for one solution, by finding the intersection of y = x(15 − x ) • 1 and y = 50 : Graph, using the calculator to find the other solution, by finding the intersection of y = x(15 − x ) • 1 and y = 50 : Graph, using the calculator to get an exact answer for one solution, by finding the zero (root) of y = x(15 − x ) • 1 − 50 : Graph, using the calculator to find one solution, by finding the (root) zero of y = x(15 − x ) • 1 − 50 : “Trace” to the x-value where the volume is 50. Two solutions. Find the intersection where y1 = y2 . Two solutions. Find the zero (root) of y1 − y2 = 0 . Two solutions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 323 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes • Does this question give an input value and ask for an output value or does the question give an output value and ask for an input value? [The question gives an output value, 50 ft3, and asks for an input value, the width.] An important discussion to have with participants is to compare the 3 different table methods and 3 different graph methods – trace, intersection, zero. • How does solving quadratic equations in many ways add to your understanding? • Why might one be more inclined to use the zero method when solving a quadratic equation and not a linear equation. [Linear equations are solved algebraically by getting all of the variables on one side and the numbers on the other side and solving for the variable. Quadratic equations are often solved algebraically by getting everything on one side equal to zero and then solving using factoring, completing the square, or with the quadratic equation.] Note: When solving linear equations, there is one solution. Often students mistakenly find only one solution to a quadratic equation when solving symbolically. Now with a picture in their heads of a quadratic equation being a parabola intersecting a line, they will be more apt to consider how many solutions they are looking for. • If you think of the solution to a quadratic equation as the intersection between a parabola and a line, how many solutions are possible? Make a sketch of each to justify your answer. [Two, one, or no real solutions.] Two solutions * • One solution No real solutions * * If you use the “zero” method, that is setting everything equal to zero and solving, how will your sketch of the possible solutions change? [The sketch is essentially the same except the line is now the x-axis, y = 0 .] Note: In this problem, we used a quadratic function to represent the volume of a sandbox as the width and length varied with a fixed perimeter and a fixed depth. The units of measure of volume are cubic, in this case, cubic feet. Some discussion may arise that area can be modeled with a quadratic function and the unit of measure is square units, while volume can be modeled with a cubic function, the unit of measure is cubic units. In the particular scenario of the sandbox, the volume can be modeled by a quadratic function because one TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 324 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes of the three dimensions, depth, is a fixed quantity. Hence, V = l ⋅ w ⋅ d = x(15 − x ) ⋅ 1, which is a quadratic function. Activity 2: Projectile Motion Have participants work through the activity, using the following to discuss. 1. • What are a reasonable domain and range for the situation? [See the above window.] Graph: Table: Home screen: Using function notation on the home screen: 2. Solution: h = 96 ft • Does this question give an input value and ask for an output value or does the question give an output value and ask for an input value? [The question gives an input value, 2 feet. and asks for an output value, the height.] 3. Solution: width = 1 ft, 4 ft TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Graph, using trace to get an Graph, using trace to get an approximation for one approximation for the other solution: solution: Spring 2001 325 III. Nonlinear Functions Table: 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes Graph, using the calculator to find one solution, by finding the intersection of y = −16 x 2 + 80 x and y = 64 : Graph, using the calculator to find the other solution, by finding the intersection of y = −16 x 2 + 80 x and y = 64 : Graph, using the calculator to find one solution, by finding the zero (root) of y = −16 x 2 + 80 x − 64 : Graph, using the calculator to find the other solution, by finding the zero (root) of y = −16 x 2 + 80 x − 64 : “Trace” to the x-value where the volume is 64. Two solutions. Find the intersection where y1 = y2 . Two solutions. Find the zero (root) of y1 − y2 = 0 . Two solutions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 326 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes • Does this question give an input value and ask for an output value or does the question give an output value and ask for an input value? [The question gives an output value, 64 ft, and asks for an input value, the time.] • How does solving quadratic equations in many ways add to your understanding? Graph: Table: 4. Solution: t = 5 sec • Does this question give an input value and ask for an output value or does the question give an output value and ask for an input value? [The question gives an output value, 0 feet. and asks for an input value, the time.] Graph, using trace to get an Graph, using the calculator approximation: to find the maximum value: 5. Solution: height = 100 ft Table, looking for the x-value that yields the highest yvalue: 6. The big idea of this question is to use the symmetry of a parabola to find the vertex. Once you know the roots of a parabola, you can find the xcoordinate of the vertex by finding the average of the roots. Then you can TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 327 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Leaders’ Notes find the y-coordinate of the vertex by substituting the x-coordinate into the equation. Answers to Reflect and Apply 2 1. a. h(2.5) = −16(2.5) + 64(2.5) , h = 60. Participants may also answer, −16 x 2 + 64 x = 60 , x = 2.5. If they do, discuss that there is another solution to the equation in addition to the one that is shown in the graph. b. −16 x 2 + 64 x = 48 , x = 1, 3 c. −16 x 2 + 64 x = 60 , x = 1.5, 2.5 ft 2. v0 = 96 sec Summary: Using the natural quadratic relationship of volume where the depth is fixed, participants build a quadratic function. They solve arising quadratic equations in several non-algebraic ways, making connections and building generalizations. Participants further their study by solving equations that arise from a projectile motion situation. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 328 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Activity 1 Activity 1: Building a Sandbox The Cano family is building a rectangular sandbox one foot deep. Diana has decided to use lumber that is one foot wide. She collected 30 feet of lumber to enclose the sandbox. 1. Sketch a few possible sandboxes. 2. Fill in the table with some possible dimensions: Width Length Depth Volume 3. Predict: what do you think a scatter plot of (width, volume) will look like? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 329 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Activity 1 4. Enter the table values into lists in your calculator, using expressions where appropriate. Create a scatter plot of (width, volume) in your calculator in an appropriate window and sketch: 5. Write the expression in the lists that you used for volume. 6. Enter the expression for volume into the function grapher. Sketch the graph over the scatter plot above. Using your function for volume: 7. If the width of the sandbox is 3.25 feet, find the volume of sand necessary to fill the box. Solve, using your calculator: Graphically With a Table TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 330 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Activity 1 8. What dimensions would allow for the greatest volume of sand? Solve, using your calculator: Graphically With a Table 9. The family decides they can afford to buy 50 ft3 of sand. What dimensions should they build the sandbox? Solve, using your calculator: Graphically With a Table TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 331 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Activity 2 Activity 2: Projectile Motion It can be shown that after being thrown straight up into the air with a velocity of 80 ft/sec, a ball’s height t seconds after being thrown can be represented by h = −16t 2 + 80t (ignoring air resistance). 1. Find an appropriate viewing window for h = −16t 2 + 80t for this problem situation. Sketch the graph. Justify your window choice. 2. How high is the ball after 2 seconds? Graphically TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 With a Table 332 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Activity 2 3. When was the ball 64 feet above the ground? Graphically With a Table 4. When did the ball hit the ground? Graphically TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 With a Table 333 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Activity 2 5. What is the maximum height that the ball reached? Graphically With a Table 6. The ball was thrown from a height of 0 ft. In Exercise 4, you found that the ball hit the ground, height = 0, at ______ sec. a. Based on this information, how can you find the time at which the ball reached its maximum height? Explain your strategy. b. Evaluate the function to find the maximum height. c. What is this point (time, maximum height) called on the parabola, h = −16t 2 + 80t ? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 334 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.1 Quadratic Relationships: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Write an equation and its solution for the following screens. a. __________________ equation __________________ solution b. __________________ equation __________________ solution c. __________________ equation __________________ solution 2. The following equation represents the height of an object after t seconds when thrown straight up from the ground: h = −16t 2 + v0 t . At what initial velocity, v0 , would you have to throw the ball to get it to a maximum height of 144 feet? (Hint: Use your graphing calculator to find v0 such that maximum height the ball reaches is about 144 feet. Graph h = −16t 2 + v0 t in the window [0, 6] [0, 150], guessing and checking values for v0 until the maximum height is 144 feet.) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 335 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes 1.2 Transformations Overview: Participants investigate the effects of changing the parameters of quadratic function of the form y = ax 2 + c . They apply this understanding by fitting a quadratic to real data. Participants extend their understanding and investigate the effects of changing the parameter h in quadratic functions of the form 2 y = ( x − h) . Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.1.B) The student investigates, describes, and predicts the effects of changes in a on the graph of y = ax 2 . (d.1.C) The student investigates, describes, and predicts the effects of changes in c on the graph of y = x 2 + c . Terms: parameter, transformation, scale factor, translation Materials: graphing calculators, patty paper Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Transformations of functions is an important concept to aid students in graphing various functions and understanding the behavior of various functions. In these activities, participants explore the effects of changing parameters of quadratic functions. They use the power of graphing calculators to find many examples quickly, make and check conjectures, and apply what they have learned. Exploring transformations with parabolas is a natural starting place as participants can watch the vertex “travel” around the coordinate system. In later courses, students will apply the lessons learned to other parent functions, and they will add other transformations to their graphing toolkit. Have participants work together in groups, comparing observations on Activities 1 – 3. Discuss their answers to Exercise 5 for each activity. Also, look at table values. See the notes for each activity for an example. Activity 1: Investigating the Role of a 2. 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 336 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes 3. 4. 5. The value a is a vertical scale factor. For a > 1, the parabola is vertically stretched. As x increases, the y-values increase faster than for y = x 2 . For 0 < a < 1 , the parabola is vertically compressed. As x increases, the y-values decrease faster than for y = x 2 . For a < 0, the graph is a reflection over the x-axis. • Does it change the shape of the graph? [For a = −1, the shape of the graph does not change. It is a reflection over the x-axis. For a > 1, the shape does change because the parabola is vertically stretched. For 0 < a < 1 , the shape also changes because the parabola is vertically compressed. Choose an Exercise and look at table values, both on the graphs and in the table as shown. Use the questions below to discuss. • • • How do the y-values (function values) of y = 2 x 2 compare with those of the parent function y = x 2 ? [The y-values are twice as much.] How do the y-values (function values) of y = 0.5 x 2 compare with those of the parent function y = x 2 ? [The y-values are half as much.] Why did the vertex remain the same? [Any number times zero is still zero, x ⋅ 0 = 0 .] This process of looking at y-values to compare functions may seem unnecessary because it is so obvious, but it lays important groundwork for students. In later courses, students will be expected to discern when a question is referring to function values (y-values) and when a question is referring to x-values. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 337 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes Activity 2: Investigating the Role of c 1. 2. 3. 4. [4.7, 4.7] [-250, 50] 15 WINDOW 5. For c > 0 , the graph is vertically translated (shifted) up c units. For c < 0 , the graph is vertically translated (shifted) down c units. • Does the shape change? [No, vertical translations are shape preserving transformations.] Put a piece of patty paper over the graph for Exercise 1 and trace the parent function y = x 2 . Slide or shift the patty paper up and down until the parent function is directly over the translated functions to show that indeed the shape does not change. • Why did we not use patty paper to look at the transformed functions y = ax 2 ? [Dilations are shape changing transformations. If you take the parent function traced on the patty paper and try to make it “fit” one of the stretched or compressed functions from Activity 1, it will not work. The shapes are different.] Choose an Exercise and look at table values, both on the graphs and in the table as shown. Use the questions below to discuss. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 338 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes • • • How do the y-values (function values) of y = x 2 + 2 compare with those of the parent function y = x 2 ? [The y-values are 2 more.] How do the y-values (function values) of y = x 2 − 3 compare with those of the parent function y = x 2 ? [The y-values are 3 less.] Why did the vertex change? [ 0 + 2 = 2 , 0 − 3 = −3 .] Activity 3: Investigating the Role of h Horizontal translations are not listed in the Algebra I TEKS. This activity is intended to enhance teachers understanding of transformations and is not intended for an average algebra I class. 1. 2. 3. 4. [-47, 47] [-31, 31] WINDOW 5. For h > 0, the graph is horizontally translated (shifted) left h units. For h < 0, the graph is horizontally translated (shifted) right h units. • Does the shape change? [No, horizontal translations are shape preserving transformations.] Put a piece of patty paper over the graph for Exercise 1 and trace the parent function y = x 2 . Slide or shift the patty paper left and right until the parent function is directly over the translated functions to show that indeed the shape does not change. Choose an Exercise and look at table values, both on the graphs and in the table as shown. Use the questions below to discuss. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 339 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes • • • How do the y-values (function values) of y = x 2 + 2 compare with those of the parent function y = x 2 ? [The y-values have all been shifted up two in the table, left two on the graph.] How do the y-values (function values) of y = x 2 − 1 compare with those of the parent function y = x 2 ? [The y-values have all been shifted down one in the table, right one on the graph.] Why did the vertex change? [The y-value of zero has been shifted too.] Activity 4: Transformations Change Add 3 to the function Multiply by 1/3 Multiply by 3 Replace x with ( x − 2) Multiply by – 1 Subtract 2 from the function Replace x with ( x + 1) Multiply by 2 Replace x with ( x − 3) New Equation y = x2 + 3 1 y = x2 3 y = 3x 2 2 y = ( x − 2) y = −x2 y = x2 − 2 Change in Graph Vertical translation up 3 Scale change of 1/3 y = ( x + 1) y = 2x2 2 y = ( x − 3) Horizontal translation left 1 Scale change of 2 Horizontal translation right 3 2 Scale change of 3 Horizontal translation right 2 Reflection over the x-axis Vertical translation down 2 2. a. Horizontal translation left 5, vertical translation down 1 b. Scale change of 3, vertical translation up 2 c. Reflection across the x-axis, scale change of 1/3, horizontal translation left 1. 2 3. a. y = 2( x − 1) 2 b. y = −( x + 2) 2 c. y = ( x − 3) − 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 340 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes d. y = ( x + 3) + 1 2 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. a. b. As the elapsed time increases, the distance from the motion detector increases. c. d. The choice for c is the minimum data value. e. • What is the significance of a = 16 in this problem? [The formula for the distance of an object dropped from an initial height of d0 at an TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 341 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes 1 2 at + d0 . The acceleration due to the 2 ft 1 force of gravity, a, is −32 , so d = ( −32)t 2 + d0 = −16t 2 + d0 . 2 sec 2 (The proof of this statement is dependent on an understanding of derivatives that are studied in calculus.) The 16 in the problem situation is positive because the motion detector is measuring the distance from the motion detector to the book instead of the distance from the book to the ground. initial velocity of zero is d = Extension: Ask participants to find first and second differences for the data. • What do the second differences imply about the choice of a quadratic function for a model for the data? [Since second differences are constant, the data can be modeled with a quadratic function.] • How are the second differences and your value for a related? [The second differences as shown below are 0.32 feet per 0.1 sec per 0.1 ft ft . The acceleration due to the force of gravity, sec, 0.32 0.1sec = 32 sec 2 0.1sec ft the force pulling the book down to the ground, is −32 . The sec 2 second difference, 32, is positive because the motion detector is measuring the distance from the motion detector to the book instead of the distance from the book to the ground. Answers to Reflect and Apply Discuss with participants the term “appropriate viewing windows,” especially with respect to the graph of quadratic functions. • What should an appropriate viewing window show about a quadratic function? [A complete graph] • What is a complete graph of a quadratic function? [The window would include x-intercepts, if any, the direction the parabola opens, and the vertex. Some participants may want to show the y-intercept.] Sample answers. Window may vary, but should show similar graphs. 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 342 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Leaders’ Notes 2. A window without the yintercept. 2. A window that shows the yintercept. 3. 4. A window that shows the yintercept. 4. A window without the yintercept. 5. 6. 7. 8. Summary: y4, A y3, D y2, C y1, B 9. y2, D 10. y1, A 11. y4, B 12. y3, C Using technology to see many examples quickly, participants connect transformations of quadratic functions with the vertex form of the equation of 2 a parabola y = a( x − h) + b . Participants use transformations to fit a quadratic function to data, i.e. the distance of a dropped object from a motion detector. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 343 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Activity 1 Activity 1: Investigating the Role of a Sketch a graph of the following using a graphing calculator. Your observations should include some table values. 1 2 2 2 2. , y = 2 x y = x , y = 0.2 x 2 1. Function: y = x 2 Observations: Observations: 3. y = 5 x , y = − x 2 2 Observations: 1 2 x , y = −25 x 2 10 Observations: 4. y = − 5. In general, what effects do different values of a have on the graph of y = ax 2 ? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 344 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Activity 2 Activity 2: Investigating the Role of c Sketch a graph of the following using a graphing calculator. Your observations should include some table values. 2. y = x 2 − 0.5 , y = x 2 − 1 1. y = x 2 , y = x 2 + 2 , y = x 2 + 3 Observations: Observations: 3. y = x 2 + 1.5, y = x 2 − 2.5 Observations: 4. y = x 2 + 15 , y = x 2 − 200 Observations: 5. In general, what effects do different values of c have on the graph of y = x 2 + c ? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 345 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Activity 3 Activity 3: Investigating the Role of h Sketch a graph of the following using a graphing calculator. Your observations should include some table values. 1 2 2 2 2 2 1. y = x , y = ( x + 2) , y = ( x + 1) 2. y = ( x − 1) , y = x − 2 Observations: Observations: 3. y = ( x − 3)2 , y = ( x + 2)2 Observations: 4. y = ( x + 22)2 , y = ( x − 15)2 Observations: 5. In general, what is the effect on the graph of y = x 2 , when you replace x with ( x + h) ? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 346 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Activity 4 Activity 4: Transformations 1. Fill in the blanks. Change from the parent function, y = x2 Add 3 to the function Replace x with ( x − 2) New Equation y = x2 + 3 Change in Graph Vertical translation up 3 Scale change of 1/3 y = 3x 2 y = − x2 Vertical translation down 2 Horizontal translation left 1 Multiply by 2 Horizontal translation right 3 2. Describe the transformations on y = x 2 that will produce the graph for each function below. Verify on your calculator. a. y = ( x + 5)2 − 1 b. y = 3 x 2 + 2 1 c. y = − ( x + 1)2 3 3. Write an equation for each graph below. Each graph is a relative of the parent function y = x 2 (shown in bold). a. b. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond c. Spring 2001 d. 347 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Activity 4 Using your knowledge of transformations on the parent function y = x 2 , graph the following relatives. Verify with your calculator. 1 4. Function: y = 2( x + 3)2 5. Function: y = ( x − 2)2 2 Describe transformations: Describe transformations: 6. Function: y = − x 2 − 1 Describe transformations: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 7. Function: y = ( x + 2)2 + 1 Describe transformations: Spring 2001 348 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Activity 4 8. A book was dropped under a motion detector. The following data was collected (elapsed time, distance from the motion detector). Elapsed Time (sec) 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 Distance from the Motion Detector (feet) 1.38 1.54 2.02 2.82 3.94 5.38 a. b. c. d. Set up a scatter plot in an appropriate window. Why is the graph increasing? Graph y = x 2 over the scatter plot. Choose a value for c and graph y = x 2 + c over the scatter plot. Explain your choice for c. e. Guess and check a value for a and graph y = ax 2 + c over the scatter plot. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 349 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.2 Transformations: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Using your knowledge of transformations on the parent function y = x 2 , find an appropriate viewing window for the following functions. Sketch each function in the window and note the window. 1. y = − x 2 − 50 2. y = ( x − 2000)2 + 5000 3. y = 0.001x 2 4. y = −500( x + 5)2 Match the function with a table: x y1 y2 y3 y4 ___ 5. -2 4 0.8 0.2 20 ___ 6. -1 1 0.2 0.05 5 ___ 7. 0 0 0 0 0 ___ 8. 1 1 0.2 0.05 5 2 4 0.8 0.2 20 x -2 -1 0 1 2 y1 1 -2 -3 -2 1 y2 5 2 1 2 5 y3 4.5 1.5 0.5 1.5 4.5 y4 2 -1 -2 -1 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Match with a graph: ___ y = 5x A y = 0.05 x 2 ___ B 2 C y = 0.2 x ___ D 2 ___ y=x 2 ____ 9. y = x 2 + 1 ___ ____ 10. y = x 2 − 3 ___ ____ 11. y = x 2 − 2 ___ 1 ____ 12. y = x 2 + ___ 2 Spring 2001 D C B A 350 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes 1.3 Lines Do It Too Overview: Participants connect their knowledge of transformations with quadratic functions with the equations of lines. The point-slope form of a line is looked at from a transformational perspective. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (c.2.C) The student investigates, describes, and predicts the effects of changes in m and b on the graph of y = mx + b . (c.2.D) The student graphs and writes equations of lines given characteristics such as two points, a point and a slope, or a slope and y-intercept. Terms: transformation, translation, dilation, increasing function, decreasing function, rate of change, slope, y-intercept Materials: graphing calculators, patty paper or blank transparencies Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. In these activities, participants explore the effects of changing parameters of linear functions. We have done similar work in previous activities in the institute, but always in context at more concrete level. Here participants move out of context to a more abstract level, using the power of graphing calculators to find many examples quickly, to make and check conjectures, and to apply what they have learned. After their work with transformations of parabolas, participants can connect those lessons with quadratic functions now to linear functions. In later courses, students will apply transformations to other parent functions, and they will add other transformations to their graphing toolkit. Activity 1: Exploring Slope Have participants work through the Exercises. Then discuss Exercise 5. 5. Some generalizations about rate of change, a, in y = ax : The larger a is, steeper the line is and the higher the rate is. The smaller a is, the more shallow the line is and the lower the rate is. If a is positive, then the function is increasing (rising from left to right). If a is negative, the function is decreasing (falling from left to right). TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 351 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes On the transparency of Exercise 1, plot the point (1, _) for each of the graphed lines as shown. (1, 5) (1, 3) • (1, 2) (1, 1) Compare the y-coordinates of these points with the a in y = ax . [The ycoordinates of these points are the same as the a in y = ax .] Tell participants that we can think of y = ax as a transformation of y = x . • What kind of transformation? [Dilation, stretch or compression by a scale factor of a.] Take the point (1,1) and stretch it to (1, a). Some participants may mistakenly think that the line is rotated by a. Looking at table values may help to show that all of the y-values of the line y = ax are a times the y-values of the line y = x . On a blank transparency, trace the line y = x and the point (1, 1) and place it on the transparency of Activity 1, Exercise 1. Rotate the transparency about the origin to show that the point (1, 1) does not rotate to the point (1, 2). The big idea of this activity is to help participants look at y = ax as a transformation of y = x , as a dilation. For a > 1, the line is vertically stretched by a scale factor of a. As x increases, the y-values increase faster than for y = x . For 0 < a < 1 , the line is vertically compressed by a scale factor of a. As x increases, the y-values decrease faster than for y = x . For a < 0, the graph is a reflection over the x-axis. Activity 2: Exploring Vertical Shifts Have participants work through the Exercises. Then discuss Exercise 3. 3. Some generalizations about the y-intercept, b, in y = x + b : [The larger b is, the higher the y-intercept. The smaller b is, the lower the y-intercept. For b > 0, the y-intercept is above x-axis. . For b < 0, the y-intercept is below the x-axis. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 352 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes In each of the graphs, plot the point (0, _) as shown. (0, 3) (0, 1) (0, 0.5) (0, 0) • Compare the y-coordinates with the point (0,0) from y = x and with the b in y = x + b . [The y-coordinates of these points are the same as the b in y = x + b .] Tell participants that we can think of y = x + b as a transformation of y = x . • What kind of transformation? [Translation, vertical shift by b.] Put a piece of patty paper over the graph for Exercise 1 and trace the parent function y = x and the point (0, 0). Slide or shift the patty paper up and down so that the point (0,0) shifts to (0,b) in all of the rest of the graphs. The big idea of this activity is to help participants look at y = x + b as a transformation of y = x , as a translation. For b > 0 , the graph is vertically translated (shifted) up b units. For b < 0, the graph is vertically translated (shifted) down b units. Before moving to the next Activity, tell participants that now we are going to look at these translations in yet another way. On the transparency, put parentheses in Exercise 1 as follows. 1 d. y = x + 1a. y = x b. y = ( x + 1) c. y = ( x + 3) 2 Ask participants to graph the following points along with you. For Exercise 1b, graph the point (-1, 0) on the line y = ( x + 1) . For Exercise 1c, graph the point (-3, 0) on the line y = ( x + 3) . 1 For Exercise 1d, graph the point (-0.5, 0) on the line y = x + . 2 (-3, 0) (-1, 0) (0.5, 0) (0, 0) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 353 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes • • • • • What do these points suggest? [That the lines have been translated horizontally.] Where else have you seen horizontal translations? [In the vertex form 2 of parabola, y = a( x − h) + k , the parent function y = x 2 is horizontally translated left h units if h < 0 and right h units if h > 0.] Looking at Exercise 2b, what does writing the function as y = ( x − 2) suggest? [It suggests that y = ( x − 2) can be graphed as a horizontal translation right 2 units.] If you horizontally translate the point (0, 0) on the parent function y = x right 2 units, what point to you get? [(2, 0)] Is (2, 0) on the line y = x − 2 ? [Yes.] With the functions written y = x + b , you can think of the graph of y = x + b as a vertical translation of y = x by b units. With the functions written y = ( x − b) , you can think of the graph of y = ( x − b) as a horizontal translation of y = x by b units . Activity 3: Exploring Horizontal Shifts Work through a few of the Exercises with participants, using the notes below. Then have participants work through the rest of the Exercises. Ask groups to present their strategies for a few of the Exercises, demonstrating how they had graphed the lines and what connections they had made between the methods. You can also use patty paper to show that both methods graph the same line. 1. y = x + 4 is a vertical translation of y = x up 4 units and y = ( x + 4) is a horizontal translation of y = x left 4 units. 2. y = ( x + 2) + 1 First graph the line y = ( x + 2) + 1 by translating the line y = x left 2 units and up 1 unit. y = x+3 Simplify y = ( x + 2) + 1 = x + 3 and graph y = x + 3 as a line with yintercept 3 and slope 1. (0, 3) (-2, 1) 3. y = ( x − 5) + 3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond y= x−2 Spring 2001 354 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes First graph the line y = ( x − 5) + 3 by Simplify y = ( x − 5) + 3 = x − 2 and translating the line y = x right 5 graph y = x − 2 as a line with yunits and up 3 units. intercept -2 and slope 1. (5, 3) (0, -2) 4. y = ( x + 1) − 4 First graph the line y = ( x + 1) − 4 by translating the line y = x left 1 unit and down 4 units. y = x−3 Simplify y = ( x + 1) − 4 = x − 3 and graph y = x − 3 as a line with yintercept -3 and slope 1. (0, -3) (-1, -4) 5. y = 2( x + 2) + 1 First graph the line y = 2( x + 2) + 1 by translating the line y = x left 2 units, up 1 unit, and then vertically stretching the line by a scale factor of 2. y = 2x + 5 Simplify y = 2( x + 2) + 1 = 2 x + 5 and graph y = 2 x + 5 as a line with y-intercept 5 and slope 2. (0, 5) (-2, 1) 6. y = 1 ( x − 4) + 3 2 y= 1 ( x − 4) + 3 2 by translating the line y = x right 4 units, up 3 units, and then vertically compressing the line by a scale 1 factor of . 2 (4, 3) First graph the line y = 1 x +1 2 1 1 ( x − 4) + 3 = x + 1 2 2 1 and graph y = x + 1 as a line with 2 1 y-intercept 1 and slope . 2 Simplify y = (0, 1) 7. y = 3( x + 1) − 4 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond y = 3x − 1 Spring 2001 355 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes First graph the line y = 3( x + 1) − 4 by translating the line y = x left 1 unit, down 4 units, and then vertically stretching the line by a scale factor of 3. Simplify y = 3( x + 1) − 4 = 3 x − 1 and graph y = 3 x − 1 as a line with y-intercept -1 and slope3. (0, -1) (-1, -4) 8. y = −2( x + 1) + 2 First graph the line y = −2( x + 1) + 2 by reflecting the line y = x across the x-axis , translating the line y = x left 1 unit, up 2 units, and then vertically stretching the line by a scale factor of 2. y = −2 x Simplify y = −2( x + 1) + 2 = −2 x and graph y = −2 x as a line with yintercept 0 and slope -2. (0, 0) (-1, 2) 9. y = −( x − 2) + 1 First graph the line y = −( x − 2) + 1 by reflecting the line y = x across the x-axis , translating the line y = x right 2 units, and then up 1 unit. (2, 1) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 y = −x + 3 Simplify y = −( x − 2) + 1 = − x + 3 and graph y = − x + 3 as a line with y-intercept 3 and slope -1. (0, 3) 356 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes 1 y = − x −1 3 1 10. y = − ( x + 3) 3 1 1 1 First graph the line y = − ( x + 3) by Simplify y = − ( x + 3) = − x − 1 3 3 3 1 reflecting the line y = x across the and graph y = − x − 1 as a line x-axis , translating the line y = x 3 1 left 3 units and then vertically with y-intercept -1 and slope − . 3 compressing the line by a scale 1 factor of . 3 (-3, 0) • (0, -1) Which method of graphing is better? [“Which is better?” is the wrong question to ask. They are both valuable methods. The emphasis is on understanding linear functions in different ways, with different representations. We want to connect different representations to build understanding. Some say that either method is valid, but to say this may imply that it is sufficient to use either exclusively, therefore limiting students’ understanding. However, the big idea is not to let everyone use what ever way they prefer, but to teach many ways of looking at something, to make connections between methods, and thus to build understanding of the concept from a wider, broader, more inclusive prospective.] Activity 4: A Different Perspective 1. Prompt participants to ask: What transformations do you need to transform the line y = x to contain the points (2, 10) and (5, 4)? You still need to find the slope. Table Time Distance 3 2 10 5 4 -6 4 − 10 ft . Now sketch the line y = x and reflect it over = −2 5−2 sec the x-axis to get the line y = − x . So the slope is TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 357 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes y = −x y=x Now sketch one of the given points, say (5, 4). The goal is to shift the line y = x so that the transformed line contains (5, 4). So, one way to do this is to first shift y = x right 5. This is written y = −( x − 5) . y = −x y = −( x − 5) right 5 Next, translate y = x up 4 units. This is written y = −( x − 5) + 4 . y = −( x − 5) + 4 up 4 y = −( x − 5) Next, vertically stretch the line by a scale factor of 2, written y = −2( x − 5) + 4 . y = −( x − 5) + 4 y = −2( x − 5) + 4 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 358 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes Of course, you could have chosen to do all of the above so that the line contained the other point (2, 10). The equation of the line above, y = −2( x − 5) + 4 , simplifies to y = −2 x + 14 , which is the result using the previous method of counting back in the table after finding the rate of change. 2. Find the rate of change, which is about 23 cm/block. Choose a point, say (1, 25). So the line y = x will be translated right 1, y = ( x − 1) , translated up 25, y = ( x − 1) + 25 , and vertically stretched by a scale factor of 23, y = 23( x − 1) + 25 . Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. The point-slope form of the equation of a line from a transformational perspective can be seen as transforming the line y = x by translating the line y = x horizontally x1 units, translating the line y = x vertically y1 units, and vertically stretching or compressing the line y = x by a scale factor of a. The vertex form of the equation of a parabola from a transformational perspective can be seen as transforming the quadratic function y = x 2 by translating y = x 2 horizontally h units, translating y = x 2 vertically k units, and vertically stretching or compressing y = x 2 by a scale factor of a. 2. The equation y = af ( x − b) + c is a general way of describing transformations of any function, f ( x ) . The variable a is the same vertical scale factor as in the two specific equations above. The variable b is horizontal translation as is the x1 in the point-slope form of the equation of a line and the h in the vertex form of the equation of a parabola. Replacing x with ( x − b) in the function f ( x ) has the effect of translating the graph of f ( x ) horizontally by b units just as the x1 and the h did for the line and the parabola respectively. The variable c a vertical translation, up if c > 0 and down if c < 0 . 3. Participants should recognize that y = 2 ⋅ f ( x ) − 1 means to vertically stretch the original function by a scale factor of 2 and vertically translate the original function down 1 unit. Therefore the graph of y = 2 sin x − 1 is TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 359 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Leaders’ Notes 4. Participants should recognize that y = − f ( x ) + 3 means to reflect the original function over the x-axis and vertically translate the function up 3 units. Therefore the graph of y = − x + 3 is Summary: Using technology to explore changing the parameters of the equation of a line, participants make connections between transformations of parabolas transformations of lines. Understanding transformations of the line y = x builds deeper understanding of the point-slope form of the equation of a line. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 360 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Activity 1 Activity 1: Exploring Slope Sketch a graph of the following in the same viewing window. 1. y = x y = 3x y = 2x y = 5x 2. y = x y = −x y = −2 x y = −5 x 3. y = x y = 0.5 x y = 0.25 x 1 y= x 5 4. y = x y = −0.5 x 1 y=− x 3 y = 0.2 x 5. Summarize the effects of a on the graph of y = ax . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 361 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Activity 2 Activity 2: Exploring Vertical Shifts Sketch a graph of the following in the same viewing window. 1 d. y = x + b. y = x + 1 c. y = x + 3 1a. y = x 2 2a. y = x b. y = x − 2 c. y = x − 1 2 d. y = x −1 3. Summarize the effects of b on the graph of y = x + b . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 362 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Activity 3 Activity 3: Exploring Horizontal Shifts 1. Describe the following in two ways: y = x + 4 . Graph the following lines in two ways. First, as transformations of y = x . Then simplify each linear function to y = mx + b or y = b + mx and graph. 2. y = ( x + 2) + 1 3. y = ( x − 5) + 3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 4. y = ( x + 1) − 4 363 III. Nonlinear Functions 5. y = 2( x + 2) + 1 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Activity 3 1 6. y = ( x − 4) + 3 2 8. y = −2( x + 1) + 2 9. y = −( x − 2) + 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 7. y = 3( x + 1) − 4 1 10. y = − ( x + 3) 3 364 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Activity 4 Activity 4: A Different Perspective The following problems are found previously in the institute. Approach them this time from a transformational perspective. 1. You looked up twice during Juan’s walk. You noted that he was at the 10 foot mark at the 2nd second and that he was at the 4 foot mark at the 5th second. Complete the table, graph, and find a rule for his walk. (Assume he was walking at a constant rate.) Table Graph Rule: 2. You collected the following data. Find a trend line. You were investigating the Height Distance relationship between the (blocks) (cm) height of the pipe and the 1 25 distance the marble rolls when 2 47.5 released in the pipe at that 3 73.75 height 4 92 5 117 Measure Trend Line: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 365 III. Nonlinear Functions 1.3 Lines Do It Too: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Discuss each of the following from a transformational perspective. How are the two equations similar? Point-Slope form of the equation of a line y = m( x − x1 ) + y1 Vertex form of the equation of a parabola y = a( x − h ) 2 + k 2. For any function, f ( x ), how do the above two equations relate to y = a ⋅ f ( x − b) + c ? Given the graphs of the following functions, sketch the indicated transformations. 4. Given f ( x ) = x 3. Given f ( x ) = sin x Sketch 2 ⋅ f ( x ) − 1 = 2 sin x − 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Sketch − f ( x) + 3 = − x + 3 Spring 2001 366 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Leaders’ Notes 2.1 Connections Overview: Participants make connections between the roots of quadratic functions and the solutions to quadratic equations and the factors of quadratic polynomials and the x-intercepts of a parabola. They connect this understanding to the vertex, polynomial, and factored form of the equation of a parabola. Using this understanding, participants model a vertical jump, finding the height of the jump. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.2.A) The student solves quadratic equations using concrete models, tables, graphs, and algebraic methods. (d.2.B) The student relates the solutions of quadratic equations to the roots of their functions. Terms: root, zero, x-intercept, factor, solution, vertex, polynomial Materials: graphing calculators, data collection devices, light sensors, laser pointers or flashlights Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. The connections between a function’s, y = f ( x ) , roots, the zeros of the graph of f ( x ) , the solution(s) to the equation f ( x ) = 0 , and the linear factors of the polynomial f ( x ) (if f ( x ) is a polynomial) are all very important connections for students to make about functions. In this activity, participants make these connections for quadratic functions. In later courses, students will apply these lessons to higher order polynomials and other functions. Activity 1: Roots, Factors, x-intercepts, Solutions Have participants complete the activity. Give a transparency of the table in Exercise 8 to a group and have them present their results. Note: The graphs are meant to be sketches using the roots. The important criteria to look for are correct roots and direction of the parabola. We are not concerned with the maximums and minimums of the parabolas in this activity. 1. 2. The x-intercepts are –3 and 2. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 367 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Leaders’ Notes 3. 4. The x-intercepts are the same. 5. ( x + 3)( x − 2) = x 2 + x − 6 Show the algebra tile (area) method for simplifying the expression. 6. The x-intercepts are the same. 7. Participants can solve the equation y4 = 0 with the graph, table, multiplication property of zero, etc. Solutions are x = −3, x = 2 . 8. If your participants do not have much experience with algebra tiles to expand expressions like ( x + 3)( x − 2) = x 2 + x − 6 , then add a column to the table that includes an area model to obtain the polynomial form. Graph y4 y1 y2 y3 (factored form) Roots x+3 x−2 ( x + 3)( x − 2) -3 and 2 y4 (polynomial form) 2 x + x−6 Solutions y4 = 0 x = −3, 2 x 2 + 3x + 2 x +1 x+2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond ( x + 1)( x + 2) Spring 2001 -2 and -1 x = −2, − 1 368 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Leaders’ Notes x 2 − 5x + 4 x−4 x −1 ( x − 4)( x − 1) x = 1, 4 1 and 4 x 2 + 7 x + 12 x+3 x+4 ( x + 3)( x + 4) x = −4, − 3 -4 and -3 x 2 − 3x x x−3 x( x − 3) x = 0, 3 0 and 3 x 2 − x − 12 x−4 x+3 ( x − 4)( x + 3) x = −3, 4 -3 and 4 x2 + 6x + 8 x+2 x+4 ( x + 2)( x + 4) x = −4, − 2 -4 and -2 x2 − x − 6 x+2 x−3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond ( x + 2)( x − 3) Spring 2001 -2 and 3 x = −2, 3 369 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Leaders’ Notes Transparency: Which Form? Ask participants to recall the situations and activities where the three different forms of a quadratic equation were explored. Sandbox problem, V = x(15 − x ) ⋅ 1, is the factored form. Projectile problem, h = −16t 2 + 80t , is in the polynomial form. 2 Transformations, y = a( x − h) + k , are in the vertex form. • What different kinds of information can you readily see from each form? [In the sandbox volume problem, V = x(15 − x ) ⋅ 1, you can quickly see the roots of the function, 0 and –15, where the volume of the sandbox is zero. In the projectile motion problem, h = −16t 2 + 80t , you can easily see the acceleration due to the force of gravity because –16 ft/sec2 is half of –32 ft/sec2. You can see the initial velocity of the ball, 80 ft/sec, and the initial height of the ball at zero feet. 2 In 1.2 Transformations, y = a( x − h) + k , you can see the scale factor and the vertex.] In Activity 2, we will work more with these different forms of a quadratic equation. Activity 2: Which Form? Work through Exercise 1 with participants. Then have them complete the rest of the activity, circulating and asking guiding questions. 1. Since the x-intercepts of the graph are –3 and 5, factors are ( x + 3)( x − 5) . −3 + 5 Average the x-intercepts = 1 so the x-coordinate of the vertex is 1. 2 Evaluate (1 + 3)(1 − 5) = ( 4)( −4) = −16 . But the y-coordinate of the vertex 1 shown is –8, so there must be a vertical scale factor of . Thus the 2 1 factored form of the equation is y = ( x + 3)( x − 5) . 2 2. Using the distributive property or an algebra tile area model, the 1 15 polynomial form is y = x 2 − x − . 2 2 1 2 3. The vertex form is y = ( x − 1) − 8 2 4. y = ( x − 6)( x − 9) 5. a. The x-intercepts are 0 and 2. b. Since the x-intercepts are 0 and 2, factors are x and ( x − 2) and the xcoordinate of the vertex is 1. As the maximum height of the ball is 4.9 meters, the y-coordinate of the vertex is 4.9. Therefore the vertex is (1, 4.9). TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 370 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Leaders’ Notes c. Evaluate y = x( x − 2) at the x-coordinate of the vertex, x = 1, y = 1(1 − 2) = −1 . But the y-coordinate of the vertex is 4.9, so there must be a vertical scale factor of –4.9. Therefore, y = −4.9 x( x − 2) is the factored form. 2 d. The vertex form is y = −4.9( x − 1) + 4.9 . e. The polynomial form is y = −4.9 x 2 + 9.8 x . • What information can be readily seen by looking at each form of the equation? [The factored form shows the x-intercepts, in this situation, the times when the ball was on the ground. The vertex form shows the vertex, in this case the maximum height of the ball. The polynomial form shows the y-intercept, in this case, the height of the ball at time=0.] 6. One way is to work backwards. 5 3 and x=− x= 2 2 5 3 (2 ) x = − (2 ) (2 ) x = (2 ) 2 2 2 x = −5 2x = 3 2x + 5 = 0 2x − 3 = 0 Therefore y = (2 x + 5)(2 x − 3) . Activity 3: Jump! Demonstrate the activity for participants, by having a participant jump when prompted by the program. Repeat if necessary to get an appropriate graph, as the example below. Then have participants complete the activity. To add a note of competition, have the three participants with the highest jump found in the experiment come to the front of the group and jump. If they leave the ground at the same time, the last one to land is the winner. See if the result matches the predicted result. The program for this activity should record intensity of light. When the jumper is standing in between the flashlight and the sensor, the sensor should record the ambient light level in the room. When the jumper jumps, the sensor should record the higher intensity level of the flashlight. When the jumper returns to the ground, the sensor should again record the ambient light level in the room. It is obviously important that the jumper takes off and lands in relatively the same place on the floor, in order to effectively block the flashlight’s light. 1. Sample data: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 371 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Leaders’ Notes 2. 3. The quadratic function to model the jump (time, height) is y = −192( x − root1 )( x − root2 ) . Recall that the position equation is 1 h = − at 2 + v0 t + h0 . The force of acceleration due to gravity is 2 ft in −32 ft 12in 1 in −32 = ⋅ = −384 and ( −384) = −192 . 2 2 2 sec sec sec 1 ft 2 sec 2 cm Participants could also use −490 to find the maximum jump in sec 2 centimeters. For our sample data, the model is y = −192( x − 0.06)( x − 0.54). 4. Jump heights from a few inches to around 15 inches are reasonable. Answers to Reflect and Apply 1a. c < 4 . The equation f ( x ) = 0 has two real solutions. b. c = 4. The equation f ( x ) = 0 has one real solution. c. c > 4 . The equation f ( x ) = 0 has no real solutions. 2. For y = Ax 2 + Bx + C , you can see the y-intercept, C. You can also see A and B which are useful for certain application problems. For y = a( x − x1 )( x − x2 ) , you can see the value of a and the roots, which are also the x-intercepts and the solutions to y = 0 . 2 For y = a( x − h) + k , you can see the value of a and the vertex (h, k), where k is the maximum or minimum value of the function. Summary: Roots, solutions, x-intercepts, and factors are often taught as isolated concepts. Bringing them all together helps participants make connections and builds understanding about the different forms of the equation of a quadratic function. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 372 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Transparency Transparency: Which Form? Match the quadratic equations with the correct form: Sandbox problem: V = x (15 − x ) ⋅ 1 Vertex form Projectile problem: h = −16t 2 + 80t Factored form Transformations: y = a( x − h)2 + k Polynomial form TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 373 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Activity 1 Activity 1: Roots, Factors, x-intercepts, Solutions 1. Graph the two functions in the same viewing window and sketch. y1 = x + 3 y2 = x − 2 2. What are the x-intercepts of the above equations? 3. Add to your sketch the graph of y3 = y1 ⋅ y2 = ( x + 3)( x − 2) . 4. How do the x-intercepts of y3 = ( x + 3)( x − 2) compare to the x-intercept of y1 = x + 3 and of y2 = x − 2 ? 5. Using algebra tiles, simplify y3 = ( x + 3)( x − 2) to rewrite in polynomial form and graph this expression in y4 . 6. How do the x-intercepts of y4 compare to those above? 7. Solve y4 = 0 . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 374 III. Nonlinear Functions 8. Complete the table. y1 y2 Graph y4 x+ 3 x− 2 x+ 1 x+ 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond y3 (factored form) ( x + 3)( x − 2) ( x − 4)( x − 1) Roots - 3 and 2 -3 and -4 Spring 2001 Solution(s) to y4 = 0 2.1 Connections: Activity 1 y4 (polynomial form) x2 + x − 6 x = −3, 2 375 III. Nonlinear Functions Graph y4 y1 y2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond y3 (factored form) Roots Spring 2001 Solution(s) to y4 = 0 2.1 Connections: Activity 1 y4 (polynomial form) y = x2 − x − 12 x = −2, 3 376 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Activity 2 Activity 2: Which Form? Write the equation of the graph in three forms: 1. Factored form 2. Polynomial form 3. Vertex form 4. Write an equation for a quadratic function that has xintercepts 6 and 9 and has a vertical scale factor of 1. 5. A soccer goalie kicks the ball from the ground. It hits the ground after 2 seconds, reaching a maximum height of 4.9 meters. a. Find the x-intercepts for the quadratic function that models the relationship (time, height). b. Find the vertex of the quadratic function. Write the quadratic function in c. factored form, d. vertex form, e. polynomial form. 6. Explain how you can find the factored form of the equation for this quadratic function, given it has a vertical scale factor of 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 377 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Activity 3 Activity 3: Jump! How high can you jump? You can use the time that you are in the air to find your vertical jump. Set up the experiment as shown, creating a photo-gate with the flashlight and the light sensor. Interrupt the signal by standing between the laser pointer and the sensor. Run the program, jumping when prompted 1. Sketch the results. 2. Trace and record the time when you left the floor and the time when you landed. 3. Use the two times to create a quadratic function that models your jump (time, height). 4. Use your function to find your maximum jump. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 378 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.1 Connections: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply 1. Name values for c such that f ( x ) = x 2 − 4 x + c satisfies each. a. The graph of f has two x-intercepts. What does this imply about the solution(s) to f ( x ) = 0 ? b. The graph of f has exactly one x-intercept. What does this imply about the solution(s) to f ( x ) = 0 ? c. The graph of f has no x-intercepts. What does this imply about the solution(s) to f ( x ) = 0 ? 2. What information can you readily see from each form of a quadratic equation? y = Ax 2 + Bx + C y = a( x − x1 )( x − x2 ) y = a( x − h ) 2 + k TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 379 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Leaders’ Notes 2.2 The Quadratic Formula Overview: Participants program the quadratic formula into the graphing calculator and use the program to solve quadratic equations at appropriate times. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.2.A) The student solves quadratic equations using concrete models, tables, graphs, and algebraic methods. Terms: quadratic equation, quadratic formula Materials: graphing calculators, 1” graph paper, markers, meter sticks Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Activity 1: Programming the Quadratic Formula Work with participants to write a program for their calculators. A sample program: Have participants check their programs by trying a simple quadratic equation like 0 = x 2 − x − 6 , x = −2, 3 • What result do you get for 0 = x 2 + x + 1 ? [Since the roots are imaginary, the calculator may return an error message or “non-real answer” or if the calculator has an imaginary mode, it may return the imaginary roots. Discuss the results with participants.] • When do you think it is appropriate for students to use the program? Extension: You could include in the quadratic formula program a conditional statement that tests whether the discriminant is negative. If b 2 − 4 ac < 0 , then the program would return a line “No real solutions.” Activity 2: Hang Time Have participants work together on the activity in groups. They should make a poster size presentation on 1” grid paper with their graphs color coded and clearly labeled. Participants will have to deal with the “Pluto problem,” that Pluto’s g is so small that it is difficult to clearly show the graphs representing the rest of the planets and include the graph representing Pluto. One way of dealing with it is the following example. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 380 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Leaders’ Notes 2. Planet Gravity at the Surface, g ft sec 2 11.84 28.16 Vertical Height Model Hang Time (sec) h(t ) = −5.92t 2 + 10t + 3 h(t ) = −14.08t 2 + 10t + 3 1.95 0.94 4. Earth 6. Mars 1. Jupiter 32 12.16 84.48 h(t ) = −16t 2 + 10t + 3 h(t ) = −6.08t 2 + 10t + 3 h(t ) = −42.24t 2 + 10t + 3 0.85 1.90 0.41 2. Saturn 2. Uranus 3. Neptune 36.80 36.80 35.84 h(t ) = −18.4t 2 + 10t + 3 h(t ) = −18.4t 2 + 10t + 3 h(t ) = −17.92t 2 + 10t + 3 0.76 0.76 0.77 8. Pluto 1.28 h(t ) = −0.64t 2 + 10t + 3 15.92 7. Mercury 5. Venus 3. 8 7 6 4 1 0.41 sec 2,3 5 0.94 sec 1.90 sec 1.95 sec 0.76 sec 0.77 sec 0.85 sec WINDOW: [0, 2] .1 [-.5, 8] 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 381 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Leaders’ Notes 7.22 ft 8 7.11 ft 4.78 ft 4.40 ft 4.36 ft 4.56 ft 3.59 ft 7 6 4 5 2,3 1 WINDOW: [0, 2] .1 [-.5, 8] 1 42.06 ft 8 15.92 sec [0, 16] 1 [-5, 45] 10 • Is this the kind of problem where it is appropriate to use technology? Answers to Reflect and Apply It makes sense to choose to solve Exercise 3 by completing the square because the value of B in Ax 2 + Bx + C is an even number, therefore making it easy to 1 find B . It makes sense to solve Exercise 2 by factoring because you can. 2 1. Solved with the quadratic formula calculator program, x ≈ −0.134, 3.195 2. Solved by factoring, x 2 + x − 12 = 0 = ( x + 4)( x − 3) , x = −4, 3. 3. Solved by completing the square, 0 = x 2 − 4 x + 1. 2 0 = x 2 − 4 x + ( −2) + 1 − 4 2 0 = ( x − 2) − 3 2 3 = ( x − 2) ± 3 = x−2 x =2± 3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 382 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Leaders’ Notes 4. Solved with the quadratic formula calculator program, x ≈ −0.25, 4.625 . 5. For Exercise 1, a ball was thrown up from a height of 2.1 meters at an initial velocity of 15 meters/sec. The 4.9 is one-half the force of gravity measured in meters per second per second. The solution to the equation answers the question, “When does the ball hit the ground?” For Exercise 4, a ball was thrown up from a rooftop 18.5 feet high at an initial velocity of 70 feet/sec. The 16 is one-half the force of gravity measured in feet per second per second The solution to the equation answers the question, “When does the ball hit the ground?” 6. 2 2 2 a. ( x + 4) b. ( x + 9) c. ( x − 5) x 2 + 8 x + 16 x 2 + 18 x + 81 x 2 − 10 x + 25 x 4 x x2 4x 4 4x 16 d. ( x + 3)( x − 2) x2 + x − 6 x 3 x x 2 -2 −2x Summary: x 9 x x2 9x 9 9x 81 e. ( x − 3)( x − 4) x 2 − 7 x + 12 -3 x x2 3x x -6 -4 −4x −3x 12 x -5 x x2 −5x -5 −5x 25 f. ( x + 6)( x + 5) x 2 + 11x + 30 x 6 x2 6x 5 5x 30 x The quadratic formula programmed into a graphing calculator can provide students with a powerful tool to solve quadratic equations. Care should be exercised about when students should use the program. In the midst of a big problem where the program is used as a tool to quickly obtain otherwise cumbersome solutions and students must ascertain at which point to use the program, certainly this is an appropriate time to use technology. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 383 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Activity 1 Activity 1: Programming the Quadratic Formula 1. Write a program that will find the roots of a quadratic equation using the quadratic formula. The program should: • Ask the user to input A, B, C from y = Ax 2 + Bx + C • Find the root(s) • Display the root(s) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 384 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Activity 2 Activity 2: Hang Time If you were to jump around on different planets, your motion would differ because the acceleration due to the force of gravity is different. Imagine that you jump from a 3 foot high platform with an initial velocity of 10 ft/sec. How would your hang time compare on each different planet? 1. Based on the values of g below, make some predictions. On which planet would you land first or last? On which planet would you jump the highest or lowest? 2. Complete the table. Planet Gravity at the Surface, g ft sec 2 Mercury 11.84 Venus 28.16 Earth 32 Mars 12.16 Jupiter 84.48 Saturn 36.80 Uranus 36.80 Neptune 35.84 Pluto 1.28 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Vertical Height Model Spring 2001 Hang Time 385 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Activity 2 3. Make a graph, showing the graphs of the jumps (time, height), each labeled with the maximum height of the jump and the time you would land on that planet. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 386 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Solve the equations. Choose one to solve by completing the square. Choose one to solve by factoring. Explain your choices. 1. 2. 3. 4. 0 = −4.9 x 2 + 15 x + 2.1 x 2 + x − 12 = 0 0 = x2 − 4x + 1 −16 x 2 + 70 x + 18.5 = 0 5. Choose two of the above equations and give them a realworld context, including what the various numbers represent and what question the equation answers. 6. Fill in the missing values. Then write two expressions for the total area for each figure. a. b. c. ? 4 x x2 ? ? ? 16 d. x ? ? ? 9x 9 ? 81 e. ? 3 x x2 ? ? ? -6 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond x ? ? x2 −5x -5 ? ? f. x ? ? x2 −3x -4 ? ? Spring 2001 x ? ? ? 6x 5 ? 30 387 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Student Activity Student Activity: Investigate Completing the Square Overview: Students investigate completing the square with algebra tiles. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.2.A) The student solves quadratic equations using concrete models, tables, graphs, and algebraic methods. Terms: complete the square Materials: algebra tiles, graphing calculator Procedures: Have students work through Exercises 1 – 4 in groups. As a whole group, discuss their answers using the following. Note: This activity assumes that students have prior experience with representing, adding and subtracting polynomials with algebra tiles (area model), with using algebra tiles to model monomial and binomial multiplication and with modeling factoring trinomials with algebra tiles. Note: This activity uses a concrete model to lay the foundation for the algebraic work of completing the square that students will do in Algebra II. 1. a. You need 9 unit tiles to complete the square. b. The dimensions of the completed square are ( x + 3) by ( x + 3) . 2 c. x 2 + 6 x + 9 = ( x + 3) 2. a. You need 16 unit tiles to complete the square. b. The dimensions of the completed square are ( x − 4) by ( x − 4) . 2 c. x 2 − 8 x + 16 = ( x − 4) 3. The number of unit tiles needed to complete the square is the square of half of the coefficient of x. For x 2 + Bx , the number of unit tiles needed is 2 B . 2 2 9 3 4. a. x 2 − 3 x + = x − 4 2 2 2 b b b. x 2 + bx + = x − 2 2 Do the following 2 examples with students. The first example is to write the equation, y = x 2 + 4 x + 5 in vertex form. Complete the square. y = x2 + 4x + 4 − 4 + 5 y = ( x 2 + 4 x + 4) − 4 + 5 y = ( x + 2) + 1 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 388 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Student Activity Have students quickly sketch a graph. The second example is to solve a quadratic equation, 0 = x 2 − 10 x + 19 , by completing the square. Complete the square: 0 = x 2 − 10 x + 19 0 = x 2 − 10 x + 25 − 25 + 19 0 = ( x 2 − 10 x + 25) − 25 + 19 0 = ( x − 5) − 6 2 6 = ( x − 5) ± 6 = x−5 x = 5± 6 2 Have students complete the rest of the Activity. 5. y = x 2 + 6 x + 4 y = x2 + 6x + 9 − 9 + 4 y = ( x 2 + 6 x + 9) − 9 + 4 y = ( x + 3) − 5 2 6. 3( x + 1) − 6 = 0 2 3( x + 1) = 6 ( x + 1)2 = 2 x +1 = ± 2 x = −1 ± 2 2 7. x 2 − 4 x − 8 = 0 x2 − 4x + 4 − 4 − 8 = 0 ( x 2 − 4 x + 4) − 4 − 8 = 0 ( x − 2)2 − 12 = 0 ( x − 2)2 = 12 x − 2 = ± 12 x − 2 = ±2 3 x =2±2 3 Summary: Using algebra tiles to complete the square based on the area model of multiplication gives students a geometric approach to understanding the algebraic steps to complete the square. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 389 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Student Activity Student Activity: Investigate Completing the Square 1. Create a partial square with algebra tiles to represent x 2 + 6 x as shown. a. How many unit tiles do you need to complete the square? b. What are the dimensions of the completed square? c. x 2 + 6 x + ? = ( x + ?)2 2. Create a partial square with algebra tiles to represent x 2 − 8 x as shown. a. How many unit tiles do you need to complete the square? b. What are the dimensions of the completed square? c. x 2 − 8 x + ? = ( x − ?)2 3. How does the number of unit tiles to complete the square compare to each respective coefficient of x? 4. Based on the above, complete the two square diagrams. b. x 2 + bx + ? = ( x − ?)2 a. x 2 − 3 x + ? = ( x − ?)2 x2 −1.5 x −1.5 x x2 b x 2 ? b x 2 ? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 390 III. Nonlinear Functions 2.2 The Quadratic Formula: Student Activity 5. Write the function in vertex form by completing the square y = x 2 + 6 x + 4 . Then sketch a graph. 6. Solve the quadratic equation written in vertex form. 3( x + 1)2 − 6 = 0 7. Solve the equation by completing the square. x2 − 4x − 8 = 0 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 391 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes 3.1 Exponential Relationships Overview: Participants explore exponential growth and decay situations. Participants develop the ideas of the common multiplier or ratio as the base of an exponential function and the starting point as the y-intercept of an exponential function. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.3.B) Given situations, the student looks for patterns and represents generalizations algebraically. (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: growth, decay, recursion, Materials: graphing calculators, sheets of blank paper Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. In this section, we explore exponential relationships similar to the way we explored linear relationships in II. Linear Functions. The connection between the linear starting point and y-intercept is analogous to the connection between the exponential starting point and y-intercept. The connection between the added constant and the slope of linear functions is analogous to the constant multiplier and the base of exponential functions. Participants will learn to write exponential functions using a starting point and a common multiplier or ratio just as they learned to write linear functions using a starting point and a common difference. Encourage participants to make connections between what is happening in the problem situation and the parameters in the exponential functions. Do the Student Activity with participants, depending on the level of your participants. Activity 1: Paper Folding Work through Activity 1 with participants. Introduce the scenario and demonstrate a couple of folds. Have participants fold a piece of paper in half as many times as they can. 1. Lead participants in filling in the table, using language similar to the following: For no folds, you have 1 layer of the piece of paper Number of folds Process Number of Layers 0 1 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 392 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes After the 1st fold, you have 2 layers. Number of folds Process 0 1 1 1⋅ 2 = 2 Number of Layers 1 2 After the 2nd fold, you have 4 layers. In other words, you have twice as many as before. • How can you write 1 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 with exponents? [ 1 ⋅ 2 2 ] Number of Process Number of Layers folds 0 1 1 1 2 1⋅ 2 = 2 2 4 1 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1 ⋅ 22 When completing the table, one is more apt to operate recursively on the previous term, continuing to multiply by 2. The emphasis here is on expressing the number of layers in terms of the number of folds in order to develop the function rule. Continue to fill in the table, establishing the pattern. Process Number of Number of folds Layers 0 1 1 1 2 1⋅ 2 = 2 2 2 4 1⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1⋅ 2 3 3 8 1⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1⋅ 2 4 4 16 1⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1⋅ 2 5 5 32 1⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1⋅ 2 6 6 64 1⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1⋅ 2 n n 1⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ . . . ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1⋅ 2 1 ⋅ 2n 1 44 2 4 43 n factors 2. Write the function as follows. • After n folds, how many 2’s will be multiplied by each other? In other words, how many factors of 2 are there is the expression? [n] • How can you write 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ . . . ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ? [ 2 n ] 1 44 2 4 43 n factors Number of folds n Process 1 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ . . . ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 1 ⋅ 2n 1 44 2 4 43 Number of Layers 1 ⋅ 2n n factors 3. Use questions to lead participants to finding a suitable viewing window. • What does x stand for in this problem? [Number of folds] • What values make sense for x in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. Zero folds to 10 folds.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 393 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes • • What does y stand for in this problem? [Total number of layers of paper] What values make sense for y in this problem? [Answers will vary. Sample answer. No layers to 2^10, which is 1024.] 4. Sample answer. The variable x stands for number of folds so zero to 10 folds shows a few more folds than I could actually fold with my piece of paper. The variable y stands for number of layers, so zero to 60 will show about all of the layers and the x-axis. 5. 1 ⋅ 2(18) = 262,144 . You will have 262,144 layers after 18 folds. 6. Because there are 5 reams of paper, you want to know when the value of y is 5 times 500, or 2500. 1 ⋅ 2 x = 2500 . You need to fold at least 12 times to get as thick as a box of paper. At the eleventh fold, the paper would only be as thick as 2048 sheets of paper, so you would need to fold it one more time, which gets you as thick as 4096 sheets of paper. A numerically powerful exercise is have participants guess and check a more exact answer to 1 ⋅ 2 x = 2500 , using the home screen. • • Explain how this answer applies to this problem situation? [It makes no sense as the domain values must be whole numbers.] Usually we solve this kind of an equation how and when? [In a typical curriculum this type of exponential equation is solved using logarithms in Algebra II and Precalculus. With the power of technology, using TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 394 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes graphs, tables, and the home screen, we can get good approximations of the solution and build understanding about exponential relationships.] Discuss the Activity: • What operation is being repeated in this problem? [multiplication] • What function results from repeated multiplication? [exponential functions] • Earlier in the institute, we worked with another repeated operation, repeated addition. What function results from repeated addition? [linear functions] • What kind of graphs result from repeated addition? [linear] • What kind of graphs result from repeated multiplication? [exponential] • Do you think this paper folding activity is an example of exponential growth or decay? [growth] Activity 2: Measure with Paper Work through the Activity with participants, discussing using the following. 1. Each sheet of paper measures approximately 0.004 inches. The measurement can be converted using dimensional analysis. 2 inches 1 ream 2 ⋅ = inches per sheet = 0.004 inches per sheet . 1 ream 500 sheets 500 2. Develop the table in the same way as Activity 1. Number of folds 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 n Process 0.004 0.004 ⋅ 2 0.004 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 0.004 ⋅ 2 2 0.004 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 0.004 ⋅ 2 3 0.004 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 0.004 ⋅ 2 4 0.004 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 0.004 ⋅ 2 5 0.004 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 0.004 ⋅ 2 6 0.004 ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 ⋅ . . . ⋅ 2 ⋅ 2 = 0.004 ⋅ 2 n 1 44 2 4 43 Thickness (inches) 0.004 0.008 0.016 0.032 0.064 0.128 0.256 0.004 ⋅ 2 n n factors 3. y = 0.004 ⋅ 2 n • How does this pattern and table compare with the table in Activity 1? [In Activity 1, we were counting layers of paper. Here we are measuring how thick the folded paper is. The output (range) values in TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 395 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes both tables are doubling each time. The starting values for each table are different.] 4. Use questions to lead participants to finding a suitable viewing window. • How might the table help you find a viewing window? 5. Sample answer. The variable x stands for number of folds so zero to 10 folds shows a few more folds than I could actually fold with my piece of paper. The variable y stands for height of the folded paper in inches, so zero to 4.1 inches ( 0.004 ⋅ 210 ≈ 4.096 ) will show most of the graph and the x-axis. 6. 0.004 ⋅ 2(15) = 131.072 . 131 ÷ 12 ≈ 10.92 so you have approximately 11 feet of paper after 15 folds. This is one foot higher than a 10 foot ceiling. It is as high as double a 5.5 foot person. 7. If the Eiffel Tower is 1050 feet tall, its height in inches is 1050 ⋅ 12 = 12, 600 . The equation you are solving here is 0.004 ⋅ 2 x = 12, 600 . When you fold the paper 21 times, the value is 8388.6. When you fold the paper 22 times, the height is 16,777, so it must be folded 22 times to reach the top of the tower. Again, a numerically powerful exercise is to have participants guess and check a more exact answer to 0.004 ⋅ 2 x = 12, 600 , using the home screen. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 396 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes • • Does this approach have meaning in the problem situation? [No, the domain values must be whole numbers.] How does the table and graph compare with the table and graph in Activity 1? [In Activity 1, we were counting layers of paper. Here we are measuring how thick the folded paper is. The output (range) values in both tables are doubling each time. The starting values for each table are different. Look at both tables.] • Find a viewing window to compare the graphs of y = 1 ⋅ 2 x and y = 0.004 ⋅ 2 x . • Compare the two rules, y = 1 ⋅ 2 x and y = 0.004 ⋅ 2 x . [They both have the same common multiplier. Each function value doubles with each increase by 1 of x.] Look at the table values again. How do you know that this data is not linear? [Look at differences. There is no common difference. Remember, if there is not a common difference, the data is not linear. We did not obtain these table values from repeated addition.] What operation is being repeated in this problem? [Multiplication] What kind of function results from repeated multiplication? [Exponential function] What is the common multiplier for Activities 1 and 2? [The common multiplier is 2 because the values double each time.] How can you find the common multiplier of 2 just by looking at the values in the table? [Divide each y-value by the previous y-value to obtain the common multiplier.] What is the relationship between the two functions? [ y2 = 0.004 y1. This is a transformation, a vertical compression.] • • • • • • TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 397 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes Activity 3: Regions Fold a piece of paper again and show participants the regions formed. Before you fold the paper, you have one region equal to the entire piece of paper. When you fold the paper once, you have two regions, each of which is onehalf the entire sheet of paper. When you fold the paper again, you have 4 regions, each of which is one-fourth the entire sheet of paper. Have participants complete the Activity. Then discuss using the following. 1. Develop the table in the same way as Activity 1. Number of folds 0 1 2 3 4 5 n Process 1 1 2 1 1 12 1⋅ ⋅ = 1⋅ 2 2 2 1 1 1 13 1⋅ ⋅ ⋅ = 1⋅ 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 14 1⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ = 1⋅ 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 15 1⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ = 1⋅ 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1n 1⋅ ⋅ ⋅ . . . ⋅ ⋅ = 1⋅ 2 42 4 2 4 24 32 2 1 1⋅ Fraction of the Piece of Paper 1 1 2 1 4 1 8 1 16 1 32 1n 1⋅ 2 n factors 1n 2 How does this pattern and table compare with the table in Activity 1? [In Activity 1, we were counting layers of paper. Here we are finding the fraction of the piece of paper for each region formed by the fold. The output (range) values in the first table are being doubled with each new fold. In the second table, the fractions are being multiplied by one-half with each new fold. The starting values for each table are different.] 2. y = 1 ⋅ • 3. Use questions to lead participants to finding a suitable viewing window. Sample: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 398 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes 4. Sample answer. The variable x stands for number of folds so zero to 8 folds shows a few more folds than I could actually fold with my piece of paper. The variable y stands for fraction of the paper for each region, so –0.1 to 1 inches will show most of the graph and the x-axis. 9 1 1 5. 1 ⋅ = = 0.001953125 . After the ninth fold, the region is one-five 2 512 hundred twelfth of the original paper. This is comparable to a sheet of paper from an entire ream of paper. Note: Some calculators have the capability to change a decimal to a fraction, which may be useful here. x 1 1 6. The equation you are solving here is 1 ⋅ = = 0.0025 . When you 2 400 1 fold the paper 8 times, you get regions that are of the paper, which is 256 1 not enough. So you must fold it 9 times to get regions that are of the 512 1 paper, smaller than of the paper. 400 Again, a numerically powerful exercise is have participants guess and 1x 1 check a more exact answer to 1 ⋅ = = 0.0025 , using the home 2 400 screen. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 399 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes • • • What meaning does this approach have in this problem situation? {None, the number of folds must be a whole number.] How does the table and graph compare with the table and graph in Activity 1? [In Activity 1, we looked at exponential growth, y = 1 ⋅ 2 x . x 1 Here we are looking at exponential decay, y = 1 ⋅ . The output 2 (range) values in Activity 1 are doubling each time. The output (range) values in Activity 2 are halving each time The starting values for each table are the same, 1.] Find a viewing window to compare the graphs of y = 1 ⋅ 2 x and x 1 y = 1 ⋅ . [The graph of exponential growth, y = 1 ⋅ 2 x , is 2 x 1 increasing. The graph of exponential decay, y = 1 ⋅ is 2 decreasing.] Activity 4: How Big is a Region? Work through the Activity with participants, discussing using the following. 1. A sheet of typing paper is 93.5 in2. 2. Develop the table in the same way as Activity 1. Number of folds 0 1 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Process 93.5 93.5 ⋅ 1 2 Spring 2001 Area of a Region 93.5 46.75 400 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes 1 1 12 93.5 ⋅ ⋅ = 93.5 ⋅ 2 2 2 1 1 1 13 93.5 ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ = 93.5 ⋅ 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 14 93.5 ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ = 93.5 ⋅ 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 15 93.5 ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ = 93.5 ⋅ 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1n 93.5 ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ . . . ⋅ ⋅ = 93.5 ⋅ 2 42 4 2 4 24 32 2 1 2 3 4 5 n 23.375 11.6875 5.84375 2.921875 93.5 ⋅ 1n 2 n factors n 1 3. y = 93.5 ⋅ 2 • How does this pattern and table compare with the table in Activity 3? [In Activity 3, we were looking at the fraction of the piece of paper for each region. Here we are measuring the area of each region. The output (range) values in both tables are halving each time. The starting values for each table are different.] 4. Use questions to lead participants to finding a suitable viewing window. Sample: 5. Sample answer. The variable x stands for number of folds so zero to 10 folds shows a few more folds than I could actually fold with my piece of paper. The variable y stands for the area of a region in inches2, so –10 to 100 inches2 will show most of the graph and the x-axis. (10 ) 1 6. 93.5 ⋅ ≈ 0.0913 . So you have approximately a tenth of a square 2 inch of paper after 10 folds. A small pill might measure 0.1 in2. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 401 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes x 1 7. The equation you are solving here is 93.5 ⋅ = 1.55 × 10 −5 . When you 2 fold the paper 23 times you get an area smaller than a plant cell. Have participants guess and check a more exact answer to x 1 93.5 ⋅ = 1.55 × 10 −5 , using the home screen. 2 Discuss the Activity. • How does the table compare with the table in Activity 3? [The output (range) values in both tables are halving each time. The starting values for each table are different. Look at both tables.] • How does the graph compare with the graph in Activity 3? Find a x 1 and viewing window to compare the graphs of y = 1 ⋅ 2 x 1 . y = 93.5 ⋅ 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 402 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes x x • 1 1 Compare the two rules, y = 1 ⋅ and y = 93.5 ⋅ . [They both 2 2 1 have the same common multiplier, . Each function value halves 2 with each increase by 1 of x. The y-intercepts, starting value, are different.] • How can you find the common multiplier of • 1 by looking at the 2 values in the table? [Divide each y-value by the previous y-value to obtain the common multiplier.] What is the relationship between the two functions? [ y2 = 93.5 y1 . This is a transformation, a vertical stretch.] Discuss all 4 Activities. Compare each table with the function that represents the table values. Note x that each function follows: y = starting point ⋅ (common multiplier ) or x y = starting point ⋅ (common ratio) . • Which functions are increasing? [The functions where the common multiplier or ratio is greater than 1 are increasing.] • What do we call increasing exponential functions? [exponential growth] • Which functions are decreasing? [The functions where the common multiplier or ratio is between 0 and 1.] • What do we call decreasing exponential functions? [exponential decay] • How can you determine the base of the exponential function b in y = a ⋅ b x from the table values? [Divide each y-value by the previous y-value.] • How can you determine the y-intercept (starting point in the problem situations), a, in y = a ⋅ b x from the table values? [The value of a is the y-value when x = 0 .] Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. y4, b 2. y3, d 3. y1, c 4. y2, a 5. ii, b 6. i, a 7. iii, c TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 403 III. Nonlinear Functions Summary: 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Leaders’ Notes Building on the work with repeated addition and linear functions, participants look at repeated multiplication and exponential functions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 404 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 1 Activity 1: Paper Folding Fold a piece of paper in half. Fold it in half again. Continue folding, filling in the table below. 1. Number Process Number of of folds Layers of Paper 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 n 2. Write a function for the number of layers of paper you will have if you fold the paper n times. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 405 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 1 3. Find a viewing window for the problem situation. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 4. Justify your window choices. Use the home screen, graph, and table to find the following: 5. If you fold the paper 18 times, how many layers of paper will you have? Write the equation. Show how you got your solution. 6. A box of paper is 5 reams of paper deep. A ream of paper has 500 sheets of paper. About how many folds would you need to be at least as thick as a box of paper? Show how you found your solution. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 406 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 2 Activity 2: Measure with Paper A ream of paper measures approximately 2 inches thick. 1. If a ream is 500 sheets of paper, approximately how thick is a piece of paper? 2. Folding paper again, build the table and find a model. Number of folds 0 Process Thickness (inches) 1 2 3 4 5 6 n 3. Write a function for how thick the stack will be, in inches, if you fold the paper n times. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 407 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 2 4. Find a viewing window for the problem situation. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 5. Justify your window choices. Use the home screen, graph, and table to find the following: 6. If you fold the paper 15 times, how many inches of paper will you have? Compare this measurement to something in the room that has approximately the same measurement. 7. The Eiffel Tower is approximately 1050 feet tall. If you had a big enough piece of paper, how many folds would you need to match or exceed that height? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 408 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 3 Activity 3: Regions When you fold the piece of paper, you split the paper into regions, bounded by the fold lines. What fraction of the piece of paper is each region formed? Complete the table below. 1. Folding paper again, build the table and find a model. Number of folds 0 Process Fraction of the Piece of Paper 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 n 2. Write a function for the fraction of a piece of paper for each region, if you fold the paper n times. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 409 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 3 3. Find a viewing window for the problem situation. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 4. Justify your window choices. Use the home screen, graph, and table to find the following: 5. If you fold the paper 9 times, what fraction of the piece of paper is each region? Write your answer as a fraction. Give an example of a different situation where that fraction might appear. 6. Your school has a paper confetti machine that cuts 8.5” by 11” sheets of paper into about 400 pieces. What is the least number of times you need to fold the paper to get regions that 1 of the piece of paper? are no larger than 400 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 410 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 4 Activity 4: How Big is a Region? A piece of paper typing paper measures 8.5” by 11” inches. 1. What is the area in inches2 of a piece of typing paper? 2. Folding paper again, build the table and find a model. Number of folds 0 Process Area of a Region 1 2 3 4 5 n 3. Write a function for the area of a region, in inches2, if you fold the paper n times. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 411 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Activity 4 4. Find a viewing window for the problem situation. Sketch your graph: Note your window: Xmin: Xmax: Xscl: Ymin: Ymax: Yscl: 5. Justify your window choices. Use the home screen, graph, and table to find the following: 6. If you fold the paper 10 times, what is the area of a region? Compare this measurement to something in real life that has approximately the same measurement. 7. Some plant cells have an area of approximately 1.55 × 10 −5 in2. How many folds do you need to have a region with at least that small of an area? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 412 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Match each function with a column in the table and with a graph: x y1 y2 y3 y4 -2 9 0.56 45 0.11 -1 3 1.67 15 0.33 0 1 5 5 1 1 0.33 15 1.67 3 2 0.11 45 0.56 9 1. y = 1 ⋅ (3) a x 1 x 2. y = 5 ⋅ 3 1 x 3. y = 1 ⋅ 3 b c d 4. y = 5 ⋅ (3) x Match each function with a recursive routine and with a graph: i. 1000, ENTER ANS*(1+0.08), ENTER . . . ii. 1024, ENTER ANS*(0.25), ENTER . . . iii. 27, ENTER ANS*(4/3), ENTER . . . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 1 5. y = 1024 ⋅ 4 x a b c 6. y = 1000 ⋅ (1.08) x 4 7. y = 27 ⋅ 3 Spring 2001 x 413 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Student Activity Student Activity: Recursion Again Overview: Students use recursive routines on the home screen to explore three exponential relationships. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: interest, recursion, fractal Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Work together with students on Exercise 1. 1. Discuss the problem. Find the interest for one year numerically. • • • • • • How do we find the interest for one year? [multiply 1000 by 0.08 to get 80.] How do we find the total amount after one year? [add 1000 and 80, which can be written 1000 + 1000 ⋅ 0.08 ] How much money would you have at the end of the first year? [$1080] How do we find the interest for year 2? [multiply 1080 by 0.08 to get 86.40] How do we find the amount after two years? [add 1080 and 86.40, which can be written 1080 + 1080 ⋅ 0.08 ]] How much money would you have at the end of the second year? [$1166.40] • Using the distributive property, how can you rewrite 1000 + 1000 ⋅ 80 and 1080 + 1080 ⋅ 0.08 ? [ 1000 + 1000 ⋅ 0.08 = 1000(1 + 0.08) and 1080 + 1080 ⋅ 0.08 = 1080(1 + 0.08) .] • What pattern do you see? [The amount for each year is equal to the amount from the year before times (1 + 0.08) .] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 414 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Student Activity • Do you think this pattern will continue? Find the amount at the end of year three in two ways. [At the end of the second year, you had $1166.40 so the interest for year three is 1166.4 ⋅ 0.08 = 93.312 . Therefore, the total amount at the end of year three is 1166.4 + 93.31 = 1259.712 , so you have $1259.71.. Using our pattern, the amount at the end of year three is 1166.4(1 + 0.08) = 1259.712 , so you have $1259.71.] We can use the pattern, that the amount for each year is equal to the amount from the year before times (1 + 1.08) , to investigate the scenario recursively on the home screen. Start students on the recursive routine and have them solve the remaining problems. a. b. c. d. e. f. g. $1080.00 $1469.33 $2158.90 10 years 15 years $46,901.61 {0, 1000}, {ANS(1)+1, ANS(2)*(1+0.08)} 2. a. b. c. d. e. Have students complete the Exercise and then discuss. 256 units2 64 units2 0.00390625 units2 stage 6 {0, 1024}, {ANS(1)+1, ANS(2)*(0.25)} TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 415 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Student Activity Note: The fractal produced by this recursive process is called the Sierpinski Triangle. 3. Have students complete the Exercise. In stage 1, you now have 4 segments that are segment. In other words, you have 1 the length of the previous 3 4 of 27, which is 36. 3 4 of each of the previous segments. In other words, you 3 4 4 4 have of of 27, which is of 36, which is 48. 3 3 3 a. 36 units b. 48 units c. 359.5939643 units d. stage 15 e. {0, 27}, {ANS(1)+1, ANS(2)*(4/3)} In stage 2, you have Note: The fractal produced by this recursive process is called the Koch Snowflake. Summary: Using repeated multiplication in recursive routines, students gain intuition for the exponential growth and decay patterns in interest and two fractals. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 416 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Student Activity Student Activity: Recursion Again 1. Suppose you have $1000 in a savings account earning 8% interest compounded annually. Solve each problem using recursion on the home screen of your calculator. a. How much money would you have at the end of the first year? b. How much money would you have at the end of five years? c. How much money would you have at the end of ten years? d. How long would it take you to double your money? e. If you have about $3,172, how long has your money been invested? f. If you wanted to retire in 50 years, how much money would you have then? g. Write the recursive routine that you used. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 417 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Student Activity 2. Given the following sequence of figures, solve each problem using recursion on the home screen of your calculator. The area of original triangle is 1024 units2. , stage 0 , stage 1 , . . . stage 2 a. What is the area of one of the smallest triangles in stage 1? b. What is the area of one of the smallest triangles in stage 2? c. What is the area of one of the smallest triangles in stage 9? d. If the area of one of the smallest triangles is 1 , what is the 4 stage number? e. Write the recursive routine that you used. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 418 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.1 Exponential Relationships: Student Activity 3. The length of the original segment is 27 units long. The 1 length of each new segment is the length of the previous 3 segment. Stage 0 Stage 1 Stage 2 a. What is the total length of the figure in stage 1? b. What is the total length of the figure in stage 2? c. What is the total length of the figure in stage 9? d. If the length of the figure is approximately 2020 units, what is the stage number? e. Write the recursive routine that you used. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 419 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Leaders’ Notes 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay Overview: Participants find models for exponential growth and decay situations. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: growth, decay, multiplier, rate, quotient, ratio, percent increase, percent decrease Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Recall the exponential relationships explored in the Student Activity: Recursion Again. If you did not do these problems with participants, divide into three groups and assign each of the groups one of the problems to investigate. Use Transparency 1 to discuss the relationship between the constant multiplier and the percent increase or decrease. You can also use Transparency 2 to develop the relationship live, using Transparency 1 as a guide. • What is the relationship between the constant multiplier and the percent increase or decrease? [The constant multiplier is one plus the percent increase for exponential growth. It is one minus the percent decrease for exponential decay.] • What does this form, writing the constant multiplier as 1+ percent increase or 1 – percent decrease, emphasize? [The percent increase or percent decrease.] • What is the multiplier for the interest earning problem? [1.08] • How can we write the constant multiplier for the interest earning problem? [1.08 or 1+0.08] • So what is the percent increase? [8%] • What is the multiplier for the triangle problem? [0.25] • How can we write the constant multiplier for the triangle problem? [1 − 0.75 ] • So what is the percent decrease? [75%] 4 • What is the multiplier for the snowflake problem? [ ] 3 • How can we write the constant multiplier for the snowflake problem? 1 [1 + ] 3 • So what is the percent increase? [33.3%] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 420 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Leaders’ Notes In the previous 3.1 Exponential Relationships, participants were given a situation and, using a table, they found exponential functions to model the situation. Now we will give participants percent increase or percent decrease, along with an initial amount and they can find exponential functions to model situations without relying on a table. Use Transparency 3 to bridge this gap from the table to the function: x y = starting amount ⋅ (rate) , where rate = 1 + percent increase for exponential growth or rate = 1 − percent decrease for exponential decay. Activity 1: Exponential Growth Have participants work together on the Activity and then discuss, using the following. 1. Write a function for each offer. x A. y = 1000(1 + 0.04) x B. y = 1000(1 + 0.03) x C. y = 1000(1 + 0.065) 2. Compare the three offers in a table. Offer A – 4% 1 year $1040.00 2 years $1081.60 5 years $1216.65 10 years $1480.24 20 years $2191.12 30 years $3243.40 Offer B – 3% $1030.00 $1060.90 $1159.27 $1343.91 $1806.11 $2427.26 Offer C – 6.5% $1065.00 $1134.23 $1370.09 $1877.14 $3523.65 $6614.37 3. Compare the three offers graphically. Ask participants to generate a list of possible questions to ask students about the three offers. These might include: • How long does it take to double your money with each offer? • How long does it take you to save $XX with each offer? • Compare the three offers over time. Have participants solve one of their questions in at least three ways and share their strategies. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 421 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Leaders’ Notes Ask participants: • What information does the graph give you that the equations do not? [The relative growth of the money over time.] • How could you find the multiplier for each offer by looking only at the table of values? [You would divide the amount at the end of year 2 by the amount at the end of year 1. This ratio is the common multiplier you use to get the amount for the next year.] • Could you divide any amount by the previous amount in this particular table? [No, because the values in the input column do not change by 1 consistently. In order to divide an outcome by a previous outcome to get the multiplier, the input values must increase by 1.] • For example, to find the multiplier for Offer A, can you divide the amount after year 5, $1216.65, by the amount after year 2, $1081.60? 1216.65 [No, ≈ 1.12 which is the percent increase over 3 years, not the 1081.60 annual percent increase.] Activity 2: Exponential Decay Explain the scenario to participants. As you eat some substances, the amount in the bloodstream eventually reaches a maximum amount. Thereafter, the substance is flushed from the bloodstream, in these cases by a certain percent every hour. We are interested in how much of the substance is remaining in the bloodstream t hours after the substance has reached the maximum level. 1. Write a function for the amount of substance remaining in the bloodstream t hours after the maximum level is reached. Encourage participants to write the functions below in both forms shown to help them later recognize both forms. t t A. y = 30 ⋅ (1 − 0.25) = 30 ⋅ (0.75) t t B. y = 30 ⋅ (1 − 0.15) = 30 ⋅ (0.85) t t C. y = 30 ⋅ (1 − 0.2) = 30 ⋅ (0.8) 2. Compare the three situations in a table. Time after Caffeine – Child Caffeine – Adult Maximum Level 1 hour 22.5 25.5 2 hours 16.88 21.68 3 hours 12.66 18.42 4 hours 9.49 15.66 5 hours 7.12 13.31 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 Vitamin 24 19.2 15.36 12.29 9.83 422 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Leaders’ Notes 3. Compare the three situations graphically. Ask participants to generate a list of possible questions to ask students about the three situations. These might include: • How long does it take to halve the amount in the bloodstream with each situation? • How long does it take you to have XX amount in the bloodstream with each situation? • When will you have less than 1 mg of each substance in the bloodstream? Have participants solve one of their questions in at least three ways and share their strategies. Ask participants: • How could you find the multiplier for each offer by looking only at the table of values? [You would divide the amount present at the end of the second hour by the amount at the end of the first hour. This ratio is the common multiplier you use to get the amount for the next hour.] • Could you divide any amount by the previous amount in this particular table? [Yes, because the values in the input column change by 1 consistently. Any quotient of successive output values in this table will give you the multiplier for this situation.] Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. y4, b 2. y3, a 3. y1, c 4. y2, d Summary: 5. 6. 7. 8. ii, b iv, c i, a iii, d The big idea in these activities is for participants to write exponential models for situations given an initial amount and a percent increase or percent decrease. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 423 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Transparency 1 Transparency 1: The Common Multiplier Sometimes it is more useful to write the multiplier as: exponential growth: (1 + percent increase) exponential decay: (1 – percent decrease) Earning 8% interest on $1000 1 + 0.08 Area of the smallest triangle , stage 0 , stage 1 , . . . stage 2 0.25 = 1 − 0.75 Total length of the segment Stage 2 4 1 = 1+ 3 3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 424 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Transparency 2 Transparency 2: The Common Multiplier Write the multiplier in terms of percent increase or decrease: exponential growth: exponential decay: Earning 8% interest on $1000 Area of the smallest triangle , stage 0 , stage 1 , . . . stage 2 Total length of the segment Stage 2 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 425 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Transparency 3 Transparency 3: Interest Suppose you have $500 in a savings account earning 6% annual interest. We can think of 6% annual interest as a 6% annual growth rate. Balance 0 1 2 3 4 t Process 500 500(1 + .06) 500(1 + .06)(1 + .06) = 500(1 + .06)2 500(1 + .06)(1 + .06)(1 + .06) = 500(1 + .06)3 Total Amount $500.00 $530.00 $561.80 $595.51 500(1 + .06)t y = starting amount ⋅ (rate) x where rate = 1 + percent increase for exponential growth and rate = 1 − percent decrease for exponential decay. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 426 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Activity 1 Activity 1: Exponential Growth Suppose you have $1000 to invest. To simplify the comparisons, consider only interest compounded annually. A. Your credit union’s savings account is offering 4% interest. B. The corner bank’s savings account is offering 3% interest. C. A Certificate of Deposit (CD) is offering 6.5% interest. 1. Write a function for each offer. A. B. C. 2. Compare the three offers in a table. 1 year 2 years 5 years 10 years 20 years 30 years 3. Compare the three offers graphically. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 427 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Activity 2 Activity 2: Exponential Decay A person drinks a caffeinated soda and takes a vitamin. The caffeine and the vitamin in the bloodstream each reach a maximum level of 30 milligrams. A. Caffeine is flushed out of a child’s blood stream at a rate of about 25% an hour. B. Caffeine is flushed out of an adult’s blood stream at a rate of about 15% an hour. C. The vitamin is flushed out of a person’s blood stream at a rate of about 20% an hour. 1. Write a function for the amount of substance remaining in the bloodstream t hours after the maximum level is reached. A. B. C. 2. Compare the three situations in a table. Time after Maximum Level 1 hour 2 hours 3 hours 4 hours 5 hours 3. Compare the three situations graphically. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 428 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Match each function with a table and a graph: x y1 y2 y3 b y4 1. y = 20 ⋅ (0.75) -2 16.5 8.89 24.7 35.6 -1 18.2 13.3 22.2 26.7 0 20 20 20 20 1 22 30 18 15 2 24.2 45 x a 2. y = 20 ⋅ (0.9) x 3. y = 20 ⋅ (1.1) x c d 16.2 11.3 4. y = 20 ⋅ (1.5) x Match each function with a recursive routine and a graph: i. 1000, ENTER ANS*(1+0.03), ENTER . . . 5. y = 1000 ⋅ (1.09) x ii. 1000, ENTER ANS*(1+0.09), a b ENTER . . . x c 6. y = 500 ⋅ (0.7) iii. 500, ENTER ANS*(0.9), 7. y = 1000 ⋅ (1.03) x ENTER . . . iv. 500, ENTER ANS*(0.7), ENTER . . . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond d 8. y = 500 ⋅ (0.9) x Spring 2001 429 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Student Activity Student Activity: On the Wall Overview: Students use different sized paper to model exponential growth and decay graphs. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: exponential function, growth, decay Materials: sticky notes, poster boards, large blank paper (for coordinate axes), markers, tape Procedures: Do this as a whole class activity. One half of the class will split into groups 1 – 4 and construct the respective graphs using sticky notes. The other half of the class will split into groups 1 – 4 and construct the same graphs using poster board or other similar sized paper. Ask the class to predict the difference in the graphs made with sticky notes and the graphs made with poster boards. Have them discuss their construction strategies. Note: These constructions only simulate exponential growth and decay. They are not accurate graphs of exponential functions. The domain for these physical models is integers. The domain for exponential functions is all real numbers. The idea here is an attempt to give students a geometric feel for exponential growth and decay by having students take slips of paper and physically double them, triple them, halve them, and cut them into thirds. Then they place the slips on a large coordinate axes system to get a concrete feel for exponential graphs. After the graphs are completed and hanging on the wall, have students do a gallery tour and note similarities and differences among the graphs. Then have a class discussion about the activity. Some points to bring out in the discussion include the following. • Why did the graphs of y = 2 x and y = 3x using sticky notes contain more in the first quadrant than did the graphs using poster board? [The poster board is so big that it did not allow students to stack many in the first quadrant. The sticky notes are small enough to allow many more to be stacked in the first quadrant.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 430 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Student Activity • • Where else did the large size of the poster board compared to the x x 1 1 sticky notes limit the graph? [In the graphs of y = and y = , 2 3 the graphs in the second quadrant were limited.] Why did the graphs of y = 2 x and y = 3x using poster board contain more in the second quadrant than did the graphs using sticky notes? [The poster board is big enough that it allowed students to halve and third many more times in the second quadrant. The sticky notes are so small that students could not split the slips into as many pieces in the second quadrant.] Sample graphs for y = 2 x : Summary: Students gain intuition about exponential growth and decay as they physically produce simulations of exponential functions using concrete materials. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 431 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Student Activity Student Activity: On the Wall Use the height of your slip of paper as a unit. Simulate the graph of the following exponential functions by using pieces of the paper and partial pieces of the paper affixed to a large grid on the wall. Sketch your graph here: 1. y = 2 x 2. y = 3 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 432 III. Nonlinear Functions 1 3. y = 2 x 1 4. y = 3 x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 3.2 Exponential Growth and Decay: Student Activity Spring 2001 433 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Leaders’ Notes 3.3 Exponential Models Overview: Participants find exponential models for given data sets. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: growth, decay, ratio, multiplier, quotient Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Participants will apply what they have learned about exponential equations to find exponential models for data. Activity 1: Population Growth Work through Exercises 1 – 4 with participants. 1. Determine the growth rate by finding successive quotients as shown below: Year Population (billions) Quotients 1980 0 4.46 4.53/4.46=1.0157 1981 1 4.53 4.61/4.53=1.0177 1982 2 4.61 4.69/4.61=1.0174 1983 3 4.69 If you find quotients on the graphing calculator, you can average the quotients. So the growth rate is about 1.0172, which is to say that the population is growing at about 1.72% per year. 2. To find an equation to model the growth using the rule t y = starting amount ⋅ (rate) , use years from 0 to 9 for 1980 to 1989. Then the starting amount (y-intercept) is 4.46. The rate is 1.0172. x Therefore, the equation to model the growth is y = 4.46 ⋅ (1.0172) . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 434 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Leaders’ Notes • How can you use the table on your calculator to check the accuracy of the model? [See below. Look to see that the model returns close to the same y-values as in the original data set.] 3. To predict the population in 1999, remember that we substituted years 0 – 9 for 1980 – 1989. So the year 1999 is year 19 for our model. Find the prediction in a few ways. 4. The year 2010 is year 30 for our model. Find the prediction in a few ways. Have participants work on Exercises 5 – 9. Make sure participants understand that they are to create a new model, using only the data in the new table. Discuss, using the following. Ask a group to present their work. 5. Determine the growth rate by finding successive quotients as shown below: Year Population (billions) Quotients 1980 0 5.28 5.37/5.28=1.0170 1981 1 5.37 5.45/5.37=1.0149 1982 2 5.45 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 435 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Leaders’ Notes If you find quotients on the graphing calculator, you can average the quotients. So the growth rate is about 1.0143, which is to say that the population is growing at about 1.43% per year. 6. To find an equation to model the growth using the rule t y = starting amount ⋅ (rate) , use years from 0 to 9 for 1990 to 1999. Then the starting amount (y-intercept) is 5.28. The rate is 1.0143. x So the equation to model the growth is y = 5.28 ⋅ (1.0143) . • How can you use the table on your calculator to check the accuracy of the model? [See below. Look to see that the model returns close to the same y-values as in the original data set.] 7. To predict the population in 2010, remember that we substituted years 0 – 9 for 1990 – 1999. So the year 2010 is year 20 for our model. Find the prediction in a few ways. 8. Using the year 1998 as year 0 for our model, the year 2010 is year 12 in our model. The population reported in 1998 was 5.92 billion so this is the x starting point. The model is y = 5.92 ⋅ (1.0133) . Find the predictions in a few ways. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 436 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Leaders’ Notes • • • Why do the three predictions for the population in 2010 differ? [Each prediction was found using a model with a different growth rate.] Compare the growth rate in the 80’s with the rate in the 90’s. [The growth rate in the 80’s was about 1.72%. The growth rate in the 90’s was about 1.43%. The growth rate decreased.] How does the growth rate reported by the UN in 1998 compare with the two rates you found? [The growth rate reported in 1998 was 1.33 percent, which is less than the two that we found. In fact the world’s population growth rate has been declining for a few years. See below and the Transparency.] Year 1962 1970 1980 1990 1998 • • Population Growth Rate 3,136,197,751 2.19 3,707,610,112 2.07 4,456,705,217 1.70 5,283,755,345 1.56 5,924,574,901 1.31 How do the growth rates shown in the Transparency compare to the rates you found? What might be some factors influencing the UN to predict lower growth rates in the future? Activity 2: Cooling Down Have participants do the Activity. Then discuss, using the following. Ask a group to present their work. 1. Find the cooling rate by taking successive quotients. The temperature is decreasing by about 4% each minute. The cooling rate is about 0.96. 2. An equation to model the temperature decrease is y = 46 ⋅ (0.96) . x TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 437 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Leaders’ Notes 3. Use the model to predict when the temperature will be 5 ˚C. Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. A linear model for 1980-1989 is y = 4.46 + 0.0822 x . 2. Compare the model and the data. The model returns slightly higher values (in billions.) 3. A linear model for 1990-1999 is y = 5.28 + 0.08 x . 4. Compare the model and the data. The model returns slightly lower values (in billions.) TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 438 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Leaders’ Notes 5. A linear model for the cooling data is y = 46 − 1.56 x . 6. The model returns slightly higher temperatures. 7. Answers will vary. Summary: The big idea in these activities is to find the multiplier from data from exponential situations by taking successive quotients. If successive quotients are constant, then an exponential model is reasonable. With the multiplier and the y-intercept, participants can find exponential models for data. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 439 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Transparency Transparency: World Population Trends World Population Size: past estimates and medium-, high- and low fertility variants, 1950-2050 (billions) *Source: United Nations Population Division, World Population Prospects: The 1998 Revision, forthcoming . TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 440 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Activity 1 Activity 1: Population Growth The Population of the World (in billions) Year 1980 1981 1982 1983 1984 1985 1986 1987 1988 1989 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Population (billions) 4.46 4.53 4.61 4.69 4.77 4.85 4.94 5.02 5.11 5.20 *1998 Revision of the official United Nations world population estimates and projections 1. Determine the growth rate. 2. Find an equation to model the population growth. 3. Use your model to predict the population in 1999. 4. Use your model to predict the population in 2010. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 441 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Activity 1 The Population of the World (in billions) Year 1990 1991 1992 1993 1994 1995 1996 1997 1998 1999 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Population (billions) 5.28 5.37 5.45 5.53 5.61 5.69 5.77 5.85 5.92 6.00 *1998 Revision of the official United Nations world population estimates and projections Create a new model, using the data in this table. 5. Determine the growth rate. 6. Find an equation to model the population growth. 7. Use your model to predict the population in 2010. 8. In 1998, the United Nations reported the current population growth rate as 1.33 per cent. Create a model using this information and the population for 1998 in the table. Use this model to predict the population in 2010. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 442 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Activity 2 Activity 2: Cooling Down A student placed a hot cup of water in the freezer and recorded the following temperatures at the indicated times. Time (min) 0 1 2 3 4 Temperature 46 44 42 41 39 (C˚) 5 6 37.5 36 7 34.5 8 33 9 32 1. Find the cooling rate. 2. Find an equation to model the temperature decrease. 3. Use your model to predict when the water will be about 5˚C. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 443 III. Nonlinear Functions 3.3 Exponential Models: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Although population and cooling data is often modeled with exponential models, a linear model can be quite accurate for short sections of data. 1. Find a linear model for the world population data for 19801989. 2. Use the table on your graphing calculator to check the model for accuracy for the years for 1980-1989. 3. Find a linear model for the world population data for 19901999. 4. Use the table on your graphing calculator to check the model for accuracy for the years for 1990-1999. 5. Find a linear model for the cooling data. 6. Use the table on your graphing calculator to check the model. 7. What do you think about the appropriateness of either model? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 444 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes 4.1 Bounce It! Overview: Collecting three sets of data from a bouncing ball experiment, participants find appropriate models and justify their choices. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (b.1.E) The student interprets and makes inferences from functional relationships. (c.1.A) The student determines whether or not given situations can be represented by linear functions. (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: linear function, quadratic function, exponential function, parameter, acceleration Materials: balls, data collection devices, motion detectors, graphing calculators Procedures: Participants should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Do all of the Activities with participants, using the data that you collect. After you have worked through an Activity with them using your data, have them complete the Activity with the data that they collect. Activity 1: Collect the Data Describe the procedure for collecting the data and demonstrate by dropping a ball under a motion detector. 1. Encourage participants to predict the graph of the ball’s distance from the floor versus time. Math Note: The data collected by the motion detector is actually the distance from the motion detector versus the time. The program we used then transformed the data to the distance from the floor versus the time. 2. It is important that the graph shows at least 5 good bounces. 3. This sample data is from a racket ball. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 445 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes Activity 2: A Bounce Do the Activity with participants, using your collected data. 1. A quadratic function is an appropriate model. To answer the question why, you can look at second differences in your data, which should be fairly constant. There will probably be some glitches around where the ball hits the floor, because you are finding differences between two sets of quadratic data (2 different bounces). 2. Find a model with participants. • How can we fit a quadratic to the first complete bounce? [A sample follows.] Graph y = x 2 over the original graph. Reflect over the x-axis by graphing y = −x2 . Trace to the vertex of the first complete bounce. Shift right 0.86 (the xcoordinate of the vertex). Shift up 2.241 (the y-coordinate of the vertex). Now guess and check the stretch factor. Does -16 have any particular significance? It is because of the acceleration due to the force of gravity in the physics position equation 1 d = at 2 + vt + d , where a is the acceleration due to gravity, which is 2 equal to -32 ft /sec2 or -9.8 m/sec2. 4. We reflected the parent function y = x 2 over the x-axis, horizontally translated it, vertically translated it, and vertically stretched it. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 446 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes 5. Now have participants find quadratics to model some of the other bounces. You may want to graph equations for all the bounces if time permits. Have participants complete the Activity using the data they collected in their groups. Activity 3: Bounce Height versus Bounce Number Do the Activity with participants, using your collected data. 1. Do not fill in the maximum height of bounce number 0. We will figure that height later. Sample data: Bounce Maximum Height of Number Bounce 0 1 2.241 2 1.709 3 1.336 4 1.01 5 0.778 6 0.607 2. Do not erase the original data, as you may need it later. Put the data into 2 different lists. If your calculator allows you to name lists, this may be a time to do so. 3. An exponential function is an appropriate model. Have participants look at first and second differences to determine that the data is neither linear nor quadratic. Note that both the first and second differences decrease, they are not constant. Take successive quotients. Note that the quotients do not continually increase or decrease, but sort of cluster around 0.77. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 447 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes 4. To find an appropriate exponential model, we need to figure the height of bounce number 0. By finding the quotients above, we found the common multiplier. • How can you use the common multiplier to work backwards to find the height of bounce number 0? [Find maximum height of bounce # 2 2.241 . For our sample data, = 2.91 .] multiplier 0.77 So for our sample data, the starting point, is 2.91 and the common x multiplier is 0.77, so our model is y = 2.91 ⋅ (0.77) Have participants complete the Activity using the data they collected in their groups. Activity 4: Bounce Height versus Drop Height Do the Activity with participants, using your collected data. 1. Use your data from the table in Activity 3. Use the height you found for bounce number 0 for the first drop height. Drop Height Bounce Height 2.91 2.241 2.241 1.709 1.709 1.336 1.336 1.01 1.01 0.778 0.778 0.607 2. Have participants predict what the scatter plot will look like before you graph it. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 448 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes 3. To find an appropriate model, first note that the domain values do not have ∆y should be a common difference. Remember, for data to be linear, ∆x ∆y ∆y constant. Find for consecutive points and you should find to be ∆x ∆x fairly constant. ∆y Our sample data found in L6. ∆x 4. So, since ∆y is fairly constant, we use a point (2.91, 2.241) and ∆x ∆y = 0.76 (from mean(L6)) in y = m( x − x1 ) + y1 to get ∆x y = 0.76( x − 2.91) + 2.241. (Stretch the line y = x by 0.76, horizontally translate it right 2.91 and vertically translate it up 2.241). Have participants complete the Activity using the data they collected in their groups. Discuss Activities 2 – 4. How do you determine if a linear model is appropriate for data? [Look ∆y , by taking first differences.] for a constant ∆x How do you determine if a quadratic model is appropriate for data? [Look for constant second differences.] How do you determine if an exponential model is appropriate for data? [Look for constant quotients.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 449 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes Note: Our purpose here is for participants to learn more about linear, quadratic, and exponential functions. Participants must know the important differences between linear, quadratic, and exponential data, use these differences to choose a model, and then they adjust parameters in the models to approximate good fits for data. This helps participants make connections between and differentiate among the three functions. Our purpose is not to teach statistical analysis. Do not get bogged down in statistical discussions. After you have completed all 4 Activities, split the group into smaller groups and work on the Student Activities as time allows. Have groups present their work. Note: The Student Activities 1 – 2: Pattern Blocks and Throw Up! are finding quadratic models for data. The Student Activities 3 –4: Radioactive Decay and Pendulum Decay are finding exponential models for data. Answers to Reflect and Apply 1. y = 0.0526 x 2 . The model is quadratic because, as seen below, the second differences are relatively constant. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 450 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Leaders’ Notes 2. y = 23000(1 − 0.15) or y = 23000(0.85) . The model is exponential because the first and second differences are not constant, but the quotients are, as seen below. x x 3. y = 16.7 − 0.007 x . The model is linear because first differences are constant. Summary: Collecting three sets of data from a bouncing ball experiment, participants find appropriate models and justify their choices. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 451 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Activity 1 Activity 1: Collect the Data 1. Read the directions below. Predict the graph of the distance of the ball from the ground versus time. 0.5 m 2. Using a motion detector, a data collection device, and an appropriate program, do the following. Hold the motion detector at least 0.5 meters above the ball. Drop the ball and let it bounce under the motion detector. Collect distance data for about 5 seconds. Collect data for a least 5 good bounces. Repeat if necessary. 3. Sketch the resulting graph: TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 452 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Activity 2 Activity 2: A Bounce 1. Choose the first complete bounce on the graph. What kind of function would be an appropriate model for this data? Why? 2. Find a model. Write the function. 3. Sketch the data and the model. 4. List the transformations you used to find the model. 5. Choose another complete bounce and find a model for that data. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 453 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Activity 3 Activity 3: Bounce Height versus Bounce Number 1. Use the trace feature to find the maximum height for each full bounce. Do not fill in the height for bounce number 0. Bounce Number 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Maximum Height of Bounce 2. Make a scatter plot of (bounce number, maximum height) in an appropriate viewing window. Sketch it. (Do not lose the original data!) 3. What kind of function would be an appropriate model? Why? 4. Find an appropriate model. Write the function. Sketch it above. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 454 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Activity 4 Activity 4: Bounce Height versus Drop Height 1. Using the data from Activity 3, fill in the table. Drop Height Bounce Height 2. Make a scatter plot of (drop height, bounce height) in an appropriate viewing window. Sketch it. (Do not lose the original data!) 3. What kind of function would be an appropriate model? Why? 4. Find an appropriate model. Write the function. Sketch it above. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 455 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Reflect and Apply Reflect and Apply Find a model for each data set and justify your choice. 1. When a car stops, the braking distance depends on the speed of the car. Speed Braking (mph) Distance (ft) 10 5 20 21 30 47 40 84 50 132 60 189 70 258 2. A car loses value each year. This is called depreciation. Year Car’s Value 0 1 2 3 4 5 $23,000 $19,550 $16,618 $14125 $12,006 $10,205 *after the driver has observed an obstacle and has begun braking 3. The air temperature outside of a plane depends on the altitude of the plane. Altitude Temperature (m) (C˚) 0 16.7 1000 9.7 2000 2.7 3000 −4.3 4000 −11.3 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 456 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 1 Student Activity 1: Pattern Blocks Overview: Students identify functional relationships using pattern blocks. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. Terms: trapezoid, rhombus, triangle, hexagon Materials: pattern blocks, graphing calculator Procedures: Students should be seated at tables in groups of 3 – 4. Explain to students that the Transparency of Hexagons is to be used with each of the patterns. Build the first Hexagon with trapezoids. Then have students complete the rest of the Activity. Note: The hexagon number is also the unit length of a side. 1. It takes 2 trapezoids to build the first hexagon. 2. It takes 8 trapezoids to build the second hexagon. 3. Hexagon Number Number of Trapezoids 1 2 2 8 3 18 n 2n2 4. Scatter plot: 5. y = 2 x 2 . To determine the parent function for the model, students can find second differences to determine that a quadratic function is an appropriate model, because second differences are constant. Have students use the homescreen, tables, and graphs to find the answers. 6. 128 trapezoids 7. 14th hexagon TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 457 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 1 8. Hexagon Number 1 2 3 4 5 n 9. Scatter plot: Number of Rhombi 3 12 27 48 75 3n 2 10. y = 3 x 2 . Again, look at second differences to determine that a quadratic function is an appropriate model because second differences are constant. Have students use the homescreen, tables, and graphs to find the answers. 11. 243 trapezoids 12. 13th hexagon 13. Hexagon Number Number of Triangles 1 6 2 24 3 54 4 96 5 150 n 6n 2 14. Scatter plot: 15. y = 6 x 2 . Again, look at second differences to determine that a quadratic function is an appropriate model because second differences are constant. Have students use the homescreen, tables, and graphs to find the answers. 16. 294 triangles 17. 15th hexagon Summary: Using pattern blocks to build hexagons, students find patterns and write function rules to model the situation. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 458 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 1 Student Activity: Transparency of Hexagons TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 459 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 1 Student Activity 1: Pattern Blocks 1. How many trapezoids does it take to build the first hexagon? 2. How many trapezoids does it take to build the second hexagon? 3. Fill in the table. Hexagon Number 1 2 3 Number of Trapezoids n 4. Create a scatter plot of (hexagon number, number of trapezoids) and sketch. 5. Find a model for the data. Use your model to find the following in at least 3 ways: 6. How many trapezoids do you need to build the 8th hexagon? 7. If you use 392 trapezoids, what hexagon number did you build? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 460 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 1 How many rhombi does it take to build the hexagons? 8. Fill in the table. Hexagon Number 1 2 3 Number of Rhombi n 9. Create a scatter plot of (hexagon number, number of rhombi) and sketch. 10. Find a model for the data. Use your model to find the following in at least 3 ways: 11. How many rhombi do you need to build the 9th hexagon? 12. If you use 507 rhombi, what hexagon number did you build? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 461 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 1 How many triangles does it take to build the hexagons? 13. Fill in the table. Hexagon Number 1 2 3 Number of Triangles n 14. Create a scatter plot of (hexagon number, number of triangles) and sketch. 15. Find a model for the data. Use your model to find the following in at least 3 ways: 16. How many triangles do you need to build the 7th hexagon? 17. If you use 1350 triangles, what hexagon number did you build? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 462 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 2 Student Activity 2: Throw Up! Overview: Students explore their own projectile motion problem and find an equation to model the height of the ball versus time. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. Terms: acceleration, velocity, speed, Materials: balls, stop watches, graphing calculators Procedures: Students should work in groups of 3 – 4. Discuss each team member’s responsibilities as you demonstrate the Activity. Throw the ball in the air and note that the timer should start timing when the ball leaves the thrower’s hand and should end timing when the ball hits the ground. Have students estimate, before they throw: How long do you think the ball will be in the air? [Students’ estimates will vary, but they will probably be much too high.] How high do you think the ball will go? With what initial velocity do you think you threw the ball? Send the groups out to collect the data. When they return, help groups understand how to guess and check their initial velocity given the time they collected. An example follows. 1. When we threw a racket ball, we timed that it was in the air for 2.55 seconds. 2. Substituting 5 for v0 , h = −16t 2 + v0 t + 5 3. We estimated that our thrower threw at 50 ft/sec, so h = −16t 2 + 50t + 5 . This initial guess is just to give students a starting place. 4. Students will need to find an appropriate viewing window and may need to adjust it as well as the initial velocity. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 463 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 2 5. The maximum height of our throw was 28.58 feet. Students can use the calculator to find the maximum of the function, use the graph to zoom in on the maximum, use the table to zoom in on the maximum, or they could even use the home screen to guess and check until they found the maximum. • What is another method of finding the initial velocity, given the time? [The equation to solve is 0 = −16t 2 + v0 t + 5 , for t = 2.55 . Solve ft 2 ] 0 = −16(2.55) + v0 (2.55) + 5 for v0 . v0 ≈ 38.839 sec Extension Questions: Assuming the initial height is 5 feet, answer the following for other throws. • How high did the ball go if its airtime was 4.5 seconds? • What was the initial velocity if the maximum height was 90 ft? • What will be the maximum height of a ball that reaches an altitude of 30 feet after half a second? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 464 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 2 • • • • • • • How long would the ball be in the air if Mark McGuire hit a ball vertically and it went up to a height of 1200 feet? How high would the ball go if Sammy Sosa hit the ball with an initial velocity of 200 feet per second? What would be the initial velocity of a ball hit vertically by Juan Gonzalez if it had an airtime of 10 seconds? Which ball went higher, Mark’s, Sammy’s, or Juan’s? What initial velocity would you need if you want the ball to go as high as the Sears tower (approximately 1454 feet)? How long would it take for this ball to complete its flight? Does it take longer for the ball to go up to its maximum height or to come down from its maximum height? Collect the times and maximum heights from the various groups. Note that the longer the ball was in the air, the higher its maximum height. Congratulate the highest thrower. Summary: Using technology, students approximate the velocity with which they threw a ball. This helps students gain intuition for velocity and also for the quadratic model. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 465 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 2 Student Activity 2: Throw Up! Go outside or to a place with a high ceiling. The thrower throws a ball straight into the air as high as he/she can. The timer times how long the ball is in the air, from the time it leaves the thrower’s hand until it hits the ground. The recorder records the time. The position equation for the height of the ball is 1 ft h = − at 2 + v0 t + h0 , where a = 32 2 , v0 is the initial velocity, 2 sec and h0 is the initial height. 1. How long was the ball in the air? 2. Assuming that the thrower released the ball at a height of 5 ft., what is the position equation for the throw? 3. How fast do you think the thrower threw the ball? In other words, what was the ball’s initial velocity? Estimate and substitute this value into the position equation. 4. Graph your equation in Exercise 3. Does it show the ball in the air for the correct amount of time? Adjust your estimate for the ball’s initial velocity until it shows the ball in the air for approximately the correct amount of time. Write your equation and sketch the graph. 5. Find the maximum height of the ball. Describe your method. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 466 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 Student Activity 3: Radioactive Decay Overview: Students use graphing calculators to simulate the radioactive decay of radon gas. They find a model for the data and use the model to predict. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: decay, radioactive Materials: graphing calculators Procedures: Students should work in groups of 3 – 4. Discuss briefly radioactive decay – that radioactive substances decay over a period of time. This means that it turns into a different material. Different radioactive materials decay at different rates over time. Not all of the material decays at the same time, but a certain percentage decays in a certain period of time. Carbon-14, a radioactive isotope found in living material, decays so slowly that scientists use it to date fossils. The half-life of Carbon-14 is 5730 years. Explain to students that they will be simulating the radioactive decay of the gas radon, which decays at a rate of about 16.7% per day. Students will find 17 random integers out of 100 to approximate the 16.7% decay rate. Explain the data collection procedure to students. Have students work through the activity in groups. Activity: 1. Encourage students to predict. 2. Sample data. First find 17 random integers between 0 – 99 for Day 1. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 467 III. Nonlinear Functions 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 1 11 21 31 41 51 61 71 81 91 2 12 22 32 42 52 62 72 82 92 3 13 23 33 43 53 63 73 83 93 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 4 14 24 34 44 54 64 74 84 94 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 6 16 26 36 46 56 66 76 86 96 7 17 27 37 47 57 67 77 87 97 8 18 28 38 48 58 68 78 88 98 9 19 29 39 49 59 69 79 89 99 Day 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Units Remaining 100 85 Next find 17 random integers between 0 – 99 for Day 2. Another way to do this is to store the generated integers into a list and then sort the list. This makes it easier to cross off the numbers because they are in order and also it makes it easier to spot duplicates, which are ignored. 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 1 11 21 31 41 51 61 71 81 91 2 12 22 32 42 52 62 72 82 92 3 13 23 33 43 53 63 73 83 93 4 14 24 34 44 54 64 74 84 94 5 15 25 35 45 55 65 75 85 95 6 16 26 36 46 56 66 76 86 96 TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 7 17 27 37 47 57 67 77 87 97 8 18 28 38 48 58 68 78 88 98 9 19 29 39 49 59 69 79 89 99 Spring 2001 Day 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Units Remaining 100 85 72 468 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 After repeating, our sample data looked like: Day Units Remaining 0 100 1 85 2 72 3 64 4 56 5 51 6 43 7 34 8 31 9 28 10 23 3. For our sample data: 4. For our sample data: 5. For our sample data, the multiplier is 0.8642 and the number of units of radon at day 0 is 100. So our model is y = 100 ⋅ 0.8642 x . Compare the table values for the model to the data. • How does this compare to the 17% that we used to simulate the 16.7% decay rate? [It should be fairly close. Try the model y = 100 ⋅ 0.17 x . Graph and compare table values.] TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 469 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 • What do you think would happen if we combined all of the data in the class? [The data should get closer to the theoretical model with a decay rate of closer to 17% because of the law of large numbers. Try it and see.] 6. Have students answer using at least 3 methods. 7. Have students answer using at least 3 methods. 8. Originally we had 100 units of radon. So we are looking for when there are half of that or 50 units of radon. For our sample data, there are 50 units left between the 4th and the 5th days. So the half life is between the 4th and the 5th days. The real half life for radon gas is approximately 3.8 days. Summary: Students use the power of technology to simulate radioactive decay. They find a model for the exponential decay data and use the model to answer questions. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 470 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 Student Activity 3: Radioactive Decay Radon is a radioactive gas that decays at a rate of about 16.67% a day. This means that after a day, the amount of radon gas present is 83.33% of the original amount. Simulate the decay of 100 units of radon gas as follows. Use your graphing calculator to randomly choose 17 integers between 0 and 99. Mark off each listed integer in the grid. These represent the decayed units of gas. Ignore any repeated integers. Count the remaining units (not crossed off) and record this in the table. Continue to do this until you have completed the table. 1. Predict the graph of (day, units remaining). TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 471 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 2. Fill in the table. Day 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Units Remaining 100 3. Create a scatter plot of (day, units remaining). 4. Find the multiplier for the decay of radon by taking successive quotients. 5. Find a model for the data using the multiplier and the number of units of radon at day 0. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 472 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 3 Use your model to find the following in at least 3 ways. 6. How much radon is left after 15 days? 7. If there are 5 units of radon left, how many days have passed? 8. What is the half-life for radon gas? In other words, after how many days will there be half of the original amount of radon left? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 473 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 4 Student Activity 4: Pendulum Decay Overview: Students collect data of the maximum swing of a pendulum versus time and find a model for the data. Objective: Algebra I TEKS (b.1.B) The student gathers and records data, or uses data sets, to determine functional (systematic) relationships between quantities. (d.3.C) The student analyzes data and represents situations involving exponential growth and decay using concrete models, tables, graphs, or algebraic methods. Terms: decay, pendulum, exponential function, quotients Materials: graphing calculators, data collection devices, motion detectors, soda cans, string, meter sticks Procedures: Students should work in groups of 3 – 4. Demonstrate the procedure for the experiment. Points for the experiment: The soda can should hang straight, not crooked. The motion detector should be at least 1.5 feet from the maximum swing of the pendulum. The motion detector should be at the same height from the floor as the hanging can. Notes on the program: The program collects data about 30 times for about 4 seconds each. It finds the maximum distance that the pendulum swings in each of those periods. It calls each of the periods “a swing” therefore there are about 30 “swings” graphed. Have students complete the data collection in their groups. Have them repeat if necessary. 1. Encourage students to predict. 2. Sample data: 3. The successive quotients cluster around 0.9. For our sample data, the mean of the successive quotients is 0.90853 and the maximum distance for TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 474 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 4 swing number 0 is 0.14857. So the model for our sample data is x y = 0.1486 ⋅ (0.9085) . 4. In other words, how many swings would you expect before the distance is half of the original distance? For our sample data, the original distance was 0.1486. So, 0.1486 ÷ 2 = 0.0743 . Thus we need to find for what swing number was the distance was 0.0743. Solve 0.0743 = 0.1486 ⋅ 0.9085 x graphically, on the home screen, in a table, etc. The half life occurs between the 7th and the 8th swing. Summary: As a pendulum swings, its swing decays. After collecting this distance data, students apply their knowledge of exponential functions to find a model for the data. TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 475 III. Nonlinear Functions 4.1 Bounce It: Student Activity 4 Student Activity 4: Pendulum Decay Construct a pendulum by tying a piece of string about 1 meter long through the pull-tab of a half-empty soda can and fixing the other end of the string to a solid point 1.5 – 2 meters off the floor. Place a motion detector about 0.5 meters from the maximum swing of the pendulum at the same height as the pendulum at rest. Run the program PENDULUM, which will collect data and plot (swing number, maximum swing of the pendulum). Gently pull back the pendulum about 50 cm and release it. 1. Predict a graph of the results. 2. Sketch the resulting graph. 3. Find a model for the data. 4. What is the half-life of the pendulum swing? TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Spring 2001 476 Calculator Programs LINETBL FnOff PlotsOff ClrDraw GridOn:AxesOn randInt(–5,5)Y randInt(–5,5)X randInt(–3,3)B randInt(–10,10)TblStart randInt(1,5)∆Tbl (Y/X)A "B+AX"Y⁄ DispTable LINEGRPH FnOff PlotsOff ClrDraw GridOn:AxesOn randInt(–5,5)Y randInt(–5,5)X randInt(–3,3)B (Y/X)A "B+AX"Y⁄ ZDecimal ACTSCRS FnOff PlotsOff ClrDraw GridOn:AxesOn randInt(–5,5)Y randInt(–5,5)X randInt(–3,3)B (Y/X)A "B+AX"Y⁄ ZDecimal PENDULUM 31N:ClrHome Send({0}) Send({1,11,2,0,0,0}) Disp "SWING, ENTER" ClrList L€ Pause For(J,1,N) Send({3,.04,99,0}) Get(L⁄) min(L⁄)L€(J) End 1-Var Stats L€ Q⁄-(Med-Q⁄)¯/(Q‹-2Med+Q⁄)K K-L€L€ seq(X,X,0,N-1)L⁄ Plot1(Scatter,L⁄,L€,␣) ZoomStat TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 477 Calculator Programs JUMPIT Full ClrHome Disp "CHECKING THE" Disp "CALCULATOR-CBL" Disp "LINK CONNECTION." {1,0}L⁄ Send(L⁄) {0}L€ Lbl M {7}L⁄ Send(L⁄) Get(L€) If dim(L€)=1 and L€(1)=0 Then ClrHome Disp "***LINK ERROR***" Disp "RE-INSERT THE" Disp "LINK CORD Disp "CONNECTORS" Disp "FIRMLY" Disp "" Disp "THEN PUSH ENTER" Pause Goto M End Disp "" ClrHome Output(6,1," STATUS: O.K." Output(8,10,"[ENTER]") Pause Full ClrHome GridOff:FnOff :PlotsOff Disp "TURN ON THE CBL" Disp "" Disp "STAND BETWEEN","PROBE AND LIGHT","ON FLOOR." Disp "" Disp "PRESS [ENTER]" Pause ClrHome Disp "JUMP WHEN READY" {1,0}L⁄ Send(L⁄) {1,1,1}L⁄ Send(L⁄) {3,0.01,88,2,1,.2,10,0,1}L⁄ Send(L⁄) Get(L€) Get(L⁄) round(L⁄,2)L⁄ Plot1(Scatter,L⁄,L€,␣) ZoomStat TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond 478 Calculator Programs CMOVE Full ClrHome Output(4,1," CBR MOTION") Output(8,10,"[ENTER]") Pause Normal Connected Full Func Float RectGC GridOff LabelOff PlotsOff FnOff ClrDraw CoordOn AxesOn ClrHome Menu("COLLECT DATA?","YES",H,"QUIT",3) Lbl 3 ClrHome Stop Lbl H 1D Disp "MOVE IN FRONT OF" Disp "THE CBR TO MAKE" Disp "A DISTANCE-TIME" Disp "PLOT." Output(8,1," [ENTER]") Pause {1,0}L⁄ Send(L⁄) {0}L€ Lbl M {7}L⁄ Send(L⁄) Get(L€) If dim(L€)=1 and L€(1)=0 Then ClrHome Disp "***LINK ERROR***" Disp "PUSH IN THE LINK" Disp "CORD CONNECTORS" Disp "FIRMLY THEN HIT" Disp "[ENTER]." Pause Goto M Else Full ClrHome TEXTEAMS Algebra I: 2000 and Beyond Full PlotsOff FnOff Func AxesOn 0Xmin 40Xmax 0Ymin 10Ymax 10Xscl 1Yscl ClrHome Lbl 0 {1,0}L⁄ Send(L⁄) {1,11,3}L⁄ Send(L⁄) ClrDraw Text(4,1,"D(FT)") Text(51,81,"T(S)") Text(1,30,"HIT [ENTER]") Text(7,34,"TO START") Pause Text(1,30," ") Text(7,34," ") {3,.1,–1,0}L⁄ Send(L⁄) 40dim(L›) For(I,1,40,1) Get(L›(I)) Pt-On(I,L›(I)) End Send({6,0}) L›L€ ClrList L› seq(X,X,0,3.9,.1)L⁄ Lbl S 0Xmin 0Ymin 10Ymax 1Yscl 4Xmax 1Xscl PlotsOff FnOff ClrDraw Plot1(Scatter,L⁄,L€,␣) DispGraph Text(4,1,"D(FT)") Text(51,81,"T(S)") StoreGDB GDB6 0U 0V Stop 479